Introduce new section flag: SEC_ELF_OCTETS
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_section_flags (newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1762 {
1763 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1764 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1769 {
1770 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1771
1772 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1776 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1777 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1778 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1779 }
1780
1781 static bfd_boolean
1782 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1783 {
1784 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1785 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1786 && section->vma <= vma
1787 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1788 }
1789
1790 static long
1791 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1792 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1793 asymbol **ret)
1794 {
1795 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1796 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1797 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1798 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1799 bfd_vma stub_off;
1800 asymbol *s;
1801 arelent *p;
1802 long count, i, stub_delta;
1803 size_t size;
1804 char *names;
1805 bfd_byte buf[4];
1806
1807 *ret = NULL;
1808
1809 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1816 if (relplt == NULL)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1820 if (plt == NULL)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1824 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1825 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1826 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1827
1828 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1829 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1830 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1831 if (dynamic != NULL)
1832 {
1833 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1834 size_t extdynsize;
1835 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1836
1837 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1838 return -1;
1839
1840 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1841 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1842
1843 extdyn = dynbuf;
1844 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1845 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1848 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1849
1850 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1851 break;
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1854 {
1855 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1856 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1857 if (got != NULL
1858 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1859 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1860 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1861 break;
1862 }
1863 }
1864 free (dynbuf);
1865 }
1866
1867 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1868 if (glink_vma == 0)
1869 {
1870 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1871 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1872 }
1873
1874 if (glink_vma == 0)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1878 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1879 glink stubs now reside. */
1880 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1881 if (glink == NULL)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1885 from the first glink stub. */
1886 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1887 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1888 {
1889 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1890
1891 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1892 insn ^= B;
1893 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1894 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1895
1896 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1897 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1898 for (i = 4;
1899 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1901 i += 4)
1902 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1903 {
1904 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1905 break;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1910 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1911 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1912 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1913 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1914 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1915 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1916 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1917 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1918 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1919 break;
1920 if (stub_delta > 32)
1921 return 0;
1922
1923 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1924 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1925 return -1;
1926
1927 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1928 p = relplt->relocation;
1929 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1930 {
1931 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1932 if (p->addend != 0)
1933 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1934 }
1935
1936 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1937
1938 if (resolv_vma)
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1940
1941 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1942 if (s == NULL)
1943 return -1;
1944
1945 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1946 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1947 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1948 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1949 {
1950 size_t len;
1951
1952 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1953 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1954 stub_off -= 32;
1955 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1956 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1957 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1958 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1959 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1960 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1961 s->section = glink;
1962 s->value = stub_off;
1963 s->name = names;
1964 s->udata.p = NULL;
1965 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1966 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1967 names += len;
1968 if (p->addend != 0)
1969 {
1970 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1971 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1972 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1973 names += strlen (names);
1974 }
1975 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1976 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1977 ++s;
1978 --p;
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1982 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1983 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1984 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1985 s->section = glink;
1986 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1987 s->name = names;
1988 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1989 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1990 s++;
1991 count++;
1992
1993 if (resolv_vma)
1994 {
1995 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1996 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1997 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1998 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1999 s->section = glink;
2000 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2001 s->name = names;
2002 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2003 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2004 s++;
2005 count++;
2006 }
2007
2008 return count;
2009 }
2010 \f
2011 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2012 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2013 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2014 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2015 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2016 called. */
2017
2018 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2019 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2020 struct plt_entry
2021 {
2022 struct plt_entry *next;
2023
2024 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2025 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2026 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2027 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2028 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2029 bfd_vma addend;
2030
2031 /* The .got2 section. */
2032 asection *sec;
2033
2034 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2035 union
2036 {
2037 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2038 bfd_vma offset;
2039 } plt;
2040
2041 /* .glink stub offset. */
2042 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2043 };
2044
2045 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2046 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2047 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2048
2049 static int
2050 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2051 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2052 {
2053 switch (r_type)
2054 {
2055 default:
2056 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2057 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2058 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2059 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2060 return 1;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_REL24:
2063 case R_PPC_REL14:
2064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2066 case R_PPC_REL32:
2067 return 0;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2070 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2071 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2074 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2075 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2076 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2077 }
2078 }
2079
2080 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2081 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2082 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2083 shared lib. */
2084 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2085
2086 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2087 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2088 {
2089 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2090
2091 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2092 asection *sec;
2093
2094 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2095 unsigned int count : 31;
2096
2097 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2098 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2099 };
2100
2101 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2102
2103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2104 {
2105 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2106
2107 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2108 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2109 from the beginning of the section. */
2110 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2111
2112 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2113 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2114
2115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2130 unsigned char tls_mask;
2131
2132 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2133 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2134 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2135 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2136 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2137
2138 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2139 symbol. */
2140 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2141
2142 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2143 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2144 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2145 };
2146
2147 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2148
2149 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2150
2151 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2152 {
2153 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2154
2155 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2156 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2157
2158 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2159 asection *glink;
2160 asection *dynsbss;
2161 asection *relsbss;
2162 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2163 asection *sbss;
2164 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2165 asection *pltlocal;
2166 asection *relpltlocal;
2167
2168 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2169 asection *srelplt2;
2170
2171 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2172 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2173
2174 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2175 bfd *old_bfd;
2176
2177 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2178 union {
2179 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2180 bfd_vma offset;
2181 } tlsld_got;
2182
2183 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2184 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2185
2186 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2187 unsigned int got_header_size;
2188 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2189 unsigned int got_gap;
2190
2191 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2192 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2193
2194 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2195 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2196
2197 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2198 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2199 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201
2202 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2203 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2206 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2207
2208 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2209 int plt_entry_size;
2210 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2211 int plt_slot_size;
2212 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2213 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2214
2215 /* Small local sym cache. */
2216 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2217 };
2218
2219 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2220 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2221
2222 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2223 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2226 relocs. */
2227 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2228
2229 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2230 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2231
2232 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2233
2234 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2235 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2236 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2237
2238 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2239
2240 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2241 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2242 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2243 const char *string)
2244 {
2245 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2246 subclass. */
2247 if (entry == NULL)
2248 {
2249 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2250 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2251 if (entry == NULL)
2252 return entry;
2253 }
2254
2255 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2256 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2257 if (entry != NULL)
2258 {
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2260 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2261 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2262 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2263 }
2264
2265 return entry;
2266 }
2267
2268 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2269
2270 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2271 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2272 {
2273 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2274 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2275 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2276
2277 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2278 if (ret == NULL)
2279 return NULL;
2280
2281 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2282 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2283 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2284 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2285 {
2286 free (ret);
2287 return NULL;
2288 }
2289
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2291 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2292 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2293 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2294
2295 ret->params = &default_params;
2296
2297 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2298 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2299 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2300
2301 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2302 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2303 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2304
2305 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2306 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2307 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2308
2309 return &ret->elf.root;
2310 }
2311
2312 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2313
2314 void
2315 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2316 {
2317 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2318
2319 if (htab)
2320 htab->params = params;
2321 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2322 }
2323
2324 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2325
2326 static bfd_boolean
2327 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2328 {
2329 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2330
2331 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2332 return FALSE;
2333
2334 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2335 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2336 {
2337 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2338 executable. */
2339 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2340 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2341 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2342 return FALSE;
2343 }
2344
2345 return TRUE;
2346 }
2347
2348 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2349 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2350 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2351
2352 static bfd_boolean
2353 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2354 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2355 flagword flags,
2356 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2357 {
2358 asection *s;
2359
2360 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2361 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2362
2363 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2364 if (s == NULL)
2365 return FALSE;
2366 lsect->section = s;
2367
2368 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2369 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2370
2371 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2372 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2373 return FALSE;
2374 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2375 return TRUE;
2376 }
2377
2378 static bfd_boolean
2379 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2380 {
2381 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2382 asection *s;
2383 flagword flags;
2384 int p2align;
2385
2386 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2387 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2388 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2389 htab->glink = s;
2390 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2391 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2392 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2393 if (s == NULL
2394 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2395 return FALSE;
2396
2397 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2398 {
2399 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2400 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2401 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2402 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2403 if (s == NULL
2404 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2405 return FALSE;
2406 }
2407
2408 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2409 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2410 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2411 if (s == NULL
2412 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2413 return FALSE;
2414
2415 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2416 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2417 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2418 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2419 if (s == NULL
2420 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2421 return FALSE;
2422
2423 /* Local plt entries. */
2424 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2425 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2426 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2427 flags);
2428 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2429 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2430 return FALSE;
2431
2432 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2433 {
2434 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2435 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2436 htab->relpltlocal
2437 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2438 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2439 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2440 return FALSE;
2441 }
2442
2443 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2444 &htab->sdata[0]))
2445 return FALSE;
2446
2447 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2448 &htab->sdata[1]))
2449 return FALSE;
2450
2451 return TRUE;
2452 }
2453
2454 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2455 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2456 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2457
2458 static bfd_boolean
2459 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2460 {
2461 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2462 asection *s;
2463 flagword flags;
2464
2465 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2466
2467 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2468 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2469 return FALSE;
2470
2471 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2472 return FALSE;
2473
2474 if (htab->glink == NULL
2475 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2476 return FALSE;
2477
2478 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2479 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2480 htab->dynsbss = s;
2481 if (s == NULL)
2482 return FALSE;
2483
2484 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2485 {
2486 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2487 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2488 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2489 htab->relsbss = s;
2490 if (s == NULL
2491 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2492 return FALSE;
2493 }
2494
2495 if (htab->is_vxworks
2496 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2497 return FALSE;
2498
2499 s = htab->elf.splt;
2500 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2501 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2502 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2503 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2504 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2505 }
2506
2507 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2508
2509 static void
2510 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2512 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2513 {
2514 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2515
2516 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2517 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2518
2519 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2520 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2521
2522 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2523 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2524 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2525 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2526 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2527 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2528 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2529
2530 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2531 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2532 return;
2533
2534 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2535 {
2536 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2537 {
2538 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2539 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2540
2541 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2542 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2543 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2544 {
2545 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2546
2547 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2548 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2549 {
2550 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2551 q->count += p->count;
2552 *pp = p->next;
2553 break;
2554 }
2555 if (q == NULL)
2556 pp = &p->next;
2557 }
2558 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2559 }
2560
2561 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2562 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2563 }
2564
2565 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2566 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2567 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2568 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2569
2570 /* And plt entries. */
2571 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2572 {
2573 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2574 {
2575 struct plt_entry **entp;
2576 struct plt_entry *ent;
2577
2578 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2579 {
2580 struct plt_entry *dent;
2581
2582 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2583 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2584 {
2585 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2586 *entp = ent->next;
2587 break;
2588 }
2589 if (dent == NULL)
2590 entp = &ent->next;
2591 }
2592 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2593 }
2594
2595 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2596 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2597 }
2598
2599 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2600 {
2601 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2602 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2603 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2604 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2605 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2606 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2607 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2608 }
2609 }
2610
2611 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2612 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2613
2614 static bfd_boolean
2615 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2616 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2617 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2618 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2619 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2620 asection **secp,
2621 bfd_vma *valp)
2622 {
2623 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2624 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2625 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2626 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2627 {
2628 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2629 put into .sbss. */
2630 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2631
2632 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2633 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2634 {
2635 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2636
2637 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2638 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2639
2640 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2641 ".sbss",
2642 flags);
2643 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2644 return FALSE;
2645 }
2646
2647 *secp = htab->sbss;
2648 *valp = sym->st_size;
2649 }
2650
2651 return TRUE;
2652 }
2653 \f
2654 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2655
2656 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2657 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2658 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2659 bfd_vma addend,
2660 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2661 {
2662 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2663 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2664 return linker_pointers;
2665
2666 return NULL;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2670
2671 static bfd_boolean
2672 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2673 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2674 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2675 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2676 {
2677 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2678 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2679 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2680 bfd_size_type amt;
2681
2682 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2683
2684 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2685 if (h != NULL)
2686 {
2687 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2688
2689 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2690 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2691 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2692 rel->r_addend,
2693 lsect))
2694 return TRUE;
2695
2696 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2697 }
2698 else
2699 {
2700 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2701
2702 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2703 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2704
2705 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2706 if (!ptr)
2707 {
2708 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2709
2710 amt = num_symbols;
2711 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2712 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2713
2714 if (!ptr)
2715 return FALSE;
2716
2717 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2718 }
2719
2720 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2721 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2722 rel->r_addend,
2723 lsect))
2724 return TRUE;
2725
2726 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2727 }
2728
2729 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2730 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2731 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2732 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2733 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2734
2735 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2736 return FALSE;
2737
2738 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2739 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2740 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2741 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2742
2743 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2744 return FALSE;
2745 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2746 lsect->section->size += 4;
2747
2748 #ifdef DEBUG
2749 fprintf (stderr,
2750 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2751 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2752 (long) lsect->section->size);
2753 #endif
2754
2755 return TRUE;
2756 }
2757
2758 static struct plt_entry **
2759 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2760 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2761 unsigned long r_symndx,
2762 int tls_type)
2763 {
2764 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2765 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2766 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2767
2768 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2769 {
2770 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2771
2772 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2773 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2774 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2775 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2776 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2777 return NULL;
2778 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2779 }
2780
2781 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2783 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2784 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2785 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2786 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2787 }
2788
2789 static bfd_boolean
2790 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2791 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2792 {
2793 struct plt_entry *ent;
2794
2795 if (addend < 32768)
2796 sec = NULL;
2797 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2798 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2799 break;
2800 if (ent == NULL)
2801 {
2802 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2803 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2804 if (ent == NULL)
2805 return FALSE;
2806 ent->next = *plist;
2807 ent->sec = sec;
2808 ent->addend = addend;
2809 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2810 *plist = ent;
2811 }
2812 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2813 return TRUE;
2814 }
2815
2816 static struct plt_entry *
2817 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2818 {
2819 struct plt_entry *ent;
2820
2821 if (addend < 32768)
2822 sec = NULL;
2823 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2824 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2825 break;
2826 return ent;
2827 }
2828
2829 static bfd_boolean
2830 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2831 {
2832 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2842 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2843 }
2844
2845 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2846
2847 static bfd_boolean
2848 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2849 {
2850 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2851 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2852 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2853 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2854 }
2855
2856 static void
2857 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2858 {
2859 _bfd_error_handler
2860 /* xgettext:c-format */
2861 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2862 abfd,
2863 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2864 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2865 }
2866
2867 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2868 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2869 table. */
2870
2871 static bfd_boolean
2872 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2873 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2874 asection *sec,
2875 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2876 {
2877 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2878 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2879 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2880 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2881 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2882 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2883 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2884
2885 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2886 return TRUE;
2887
2888 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2889 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2890 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2891 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2892 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2893 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2894 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2895 return TRUE;
2896
2897 #ifdef DEBUG
2898 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2899 sec, abfd);
2900 #endif
2901
2902 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2903
2904 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2905 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2906 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2907
2908 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2909 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2910 {
2911 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2912 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2913 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2914 return FALSE;
2915 }
2916 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2917 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2918 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2919 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2920 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2921 sreloc = NULL;
2922
2923 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2924 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2925 {
2926 unsigned long r_symndx;
2927 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2928 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2929 int tls_type;
2930 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2931 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2932 bfd_vma addend;
2933
2934 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2935 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2936 h = NULL;
2937 else
2938 {
2939 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2940 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2941 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2942 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2943 }
2944
2945 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2946 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2947 startup code. */
2948 if (h != NULL
2949 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2950 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2951 {
2952 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2953 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2954 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2955 return FALSE;
2956 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2957 }
2958
2959 tls_type = 0;
2960 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2961 ifunc = NULL;
2962 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2963 {
2964 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2965 abfd, r_symndx);
2966 if (isym == NULL)
2967 return FALSE;
2968
2969 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2970 {
2971 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2972 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2973 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2974 if (ifunc == NULL)
2975 return FALSE;
2976
2977 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2978 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2979 no plt calls. */
2980 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2981 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2982 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2984 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2985 {
2986 addend = 0;
2987 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2988 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2989 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2990 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2991 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2992 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2993 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2994 addend = rel->r_addend;
2995 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2996 return FALSE;
2997 }
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3002 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3003 && h != NULL
3004 && h == tga)
3005 {
3006 if (rel != relocs
3007 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3008 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3009 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3010 reloc. */
3011 ;
3012 else
3013 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3014 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3015 }
3016
3017 switch (r_type)
3018 {
3019 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3020 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3021 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3022 its parameter symbol. */
3023 if (h != NULL)
3024 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3025 else
3026 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3027 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3028 return FALSE;
3029 break;
3030
3031 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3032 break;
3033
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3037 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3038 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3039 goto dogottls;
3040
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3044 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3045 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3046 goto dogottls;
3047
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3052 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3053 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3054 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3055 goto dogottls;
3056
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3059 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3060 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3061 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3062 dogottls:
3063 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3064 /* Fall through. */
3065
3066 /* GOT16 relocations */
3067 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3068 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3069 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3070 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3071 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3072 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3073 {
3074 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3075 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3076 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3077 return FALSE;
3078 }
3079 if (h != NULL)
3080 {
3081 h->got.refcount += 1;
3082 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3083 }
3084 else
3085 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3086 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3087 return FALSE;
3088
3089 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3090 an ifunc. */
3091 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3092 {
3093 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3094 return FALSE;
3095 }
3096 break;
3097
3098 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3099 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3100 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3101 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3102 h, rel))
3103 return FALSE;
3104 if (h != NULL)
3105 {
3106 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3107 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3108 }
3109 break;
3110
3111 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3112 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3113 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3114 {
3115 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3116 return FALSE;
3117 }
3118 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3119 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3120 h, rel))
3121 return FALSE;
3122 if (h != NULL)
3123 {
3124 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3125 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3126 }
3127 break;
3128
3129 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3130 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3131 /* Fall through. */
3132
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3138 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3139 if (h != NULL)
3140 {
3141 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3142 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3143 }
3144 break;
3145
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3155 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3156 break;
3157
3158 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3159 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3160 {
3161 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3162 return FALSE;
3163 }
3164 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3165 if (h != NULL)
3166 {
3167 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3168 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3169 }
3170 break;
3171
3172 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3173 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3175 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3176 if (h != NULL)
3177 {
3178 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3179 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3180 }
3181 break;
3182
3183 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3184 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3185 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3187 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3188 if (h != NULL)
3189 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3190 break;
3191
3192 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3193 if (h == NULL)
3194 break;
3195 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3196 goto pltentry;
3197
3198 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3199 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3200 /* Fall through. */
3201
3202 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3203 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3204 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3205 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3206 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3207 pltentry:
3208 #ifdef DEBUG
3209 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3210 #endif
3211 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3212 if (h == NULL)
3213 {
3214 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3215 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3216 if (pltent == NULL)
3217 return FALSE;
3218 }
3219 else
3220 {
3221 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3222 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3223 h->needs_plt = 1;
3224 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3225 }
3226 addend = 0;
3227 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3228 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3229 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3230 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3231 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3232 addend = rel->r_addend;
3233 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3234 return FALSE;
3235 break;
3236
3237 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3238 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3239 section relative. */
3240 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3241 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3242 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3243 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3244 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3245 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3246 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3247 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3248 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3249 break;
3250
3251 case R_PPC_REL16:
3252 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3253 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3254 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3255 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3256 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3257 break;
3258
3259 /* These are just markers. */
3260 case R_PPC_TLS:
3261 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3262 case R_PPC_NONE:
3263 case R_PPC_max:
3264 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3265 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3266 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3267 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3268 break;
3269
3270 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3271 case R_PPC_COPY:
3272 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3273 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3274 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3275 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3276 break;
3277
3278 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3279 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3280 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3281 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3282 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3283 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3284 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3285 break;
3286
3287 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3288 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3289 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3290 {
3291 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3292 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3293 }
3294 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3295 {
3296 h->needs_plt = 1;
3297 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3298 return FALSE;
3299 }
3300 break;
3301
3302 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3303 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3304 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3305 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3306 return FALSE;
3307 break;
3308
3309 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3310 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3311 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3312 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3313 return FALSE;
3314 break;
3315
3316 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3317 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3318 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3319 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3320 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3321 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3322 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3323 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3324 goto dodyn;
3325
3326 /* Nor these. */
3327 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3328 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3329 goto dodyn;
3330
3331 case R_PPC_REL32:
3332 if (h == NULL
3333 && got2 != NULL
3334 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3335 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3336 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3337 {
3338 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3339 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3340 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3341 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3342 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3343 PLT call stubs. */
3344 asection *s;
3345 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3346
3347 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3348 abfd, r_symndx);
3349 if (isym == NULL)
3350 return FALSE;
3351
3352 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3353 if (s == got2)
3354 {
3355 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3356 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3357 }
3358 }
3359 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3360 break;
3361 /* fall through */
3362
3363 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3364 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3365 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3366 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3367 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3368 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3369 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3370 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3371 {
3372 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3373 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3374 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3375 return FALSE;
3376
3377 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3378 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3379 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3380 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3381 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3382 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3383 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3384 }
3385 goto dodyn;
3386
3387 case R_PPC_REL24:
3388 case R_PPC_REL14:
3389 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3390 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3391 if (h == NULL)
3392 break;
3393 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3394 {
3395 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3396 {
3397 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3398 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3399 }
3400 break;
3401 }
3402 /* fall through */
3403
3404 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3405 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3406 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3407 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3408 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3409 {
3410 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3411 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3412 h->needs_plt = 1;
3413 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3414 return FALSE;
3415 break;
3416 }
3417
3418 dodyn:
3419 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3420 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3421 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3422 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3423 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3424 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3425 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3426 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3427 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3428 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3429 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3430 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3431 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3432 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3433 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3434 symbol local.
3435
3436 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3437 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3438 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3439 symbol. */
3440 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3441 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3442 || (h != NULL
3443 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3444 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3445 || !h->def_regular))))
3446 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3447 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3448 && h != NULL
3449 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3450 || !h->def_regular)))
3451 {
3452 #ifdef DEBUG
3453 fprintf (stderr,
3454 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3455 "create relocation for %s\n",
3456 (h && h->root.root.string
3457 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3458 #endif
3459 if (sreloc == NULL)
3460 {
3461 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3462 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3463
3464 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3465 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3466
3467 if (sreloc == NULL)
3468 return FALSE;
3469 }
3470
3471 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3472 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3473 if (h != NULL)
3474 {
3475 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3476 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3477
3478 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3479 p = *rel_head;
3480 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3481 {
3482 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3483 if (p == NULL)
3484 return FALSE;
3485 p->next = *rel_head;
3486 *rel_head = p;
3487 p->sec = sec;
3488 p->count = 0;
3489 p->pc_count = 0;
3490 }
3491 p->count += 1;
3492 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3493 p->pc_count += 1;
3494 }
3495 else
3496 {
3497 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3498 We really need local syms available to do this
3499 easily. Oh well. */
3500 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3501 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3502 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3503 asection *s;
3504 void *vpp;
3505 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3506
3507 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3508 abfd, r_symndx);
3509 if (isym == NULL)
3510 return FALSE;
3511
3512 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3513 if (s == NULL)
3514 s = sec;
3515
3516 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3517 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3518 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3519 p = *rel_head;
3520 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3521 p = p->next;
3522 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3523 {
3524 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3525 if (p == NULL)
3526 return FALSE;
3527 p->next = *rel_head;
3528 *rel_head = p;
3529 p->sec = sec;
3530 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3531 p->count = 0;
3532 }
3533 p->count += 1;
3534 }
3535 }
3536
3537 break;
3538 }
3539 }
3540
3541 return TRUE;
3542 }
3543 \f
3544 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3545 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3546 bfd_boolean
3547 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3548 {
3549 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3550 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3551 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3552 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3553
3554 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3556
3557 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3559
3560 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3561 {
3562 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3563 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3564 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3565
3566 if (in_fp == 0)
3567 ;
3568 else if (out_fp == 0)
3569 {
3570 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3571 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3572 last_fp = ibfd;
3573 }
3574 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3575 {
3576 _bfd_error_handler
3577 /* xgettext:c-format */
3578 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3579 last_fp, ibfd);
3580 ret = FALSE;
3581 }
3582 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3583 {
3584 _bfd_error_handler
3585 /* xgettext:c-format */
3586 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3587 ibfd, last_fp);
3588 ret = FALSE;
3589 }
3590 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3591 {
3592 _bfd_error_handler
3593 /* xgettext:c-format */
3594 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3595 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3596 ret = FALSE;
3597 }
3598 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3599 {
3600 _bfd_error_handler
3601 /* xgettext:c-format */
3602 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3603 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3604 ret = FALSE;
3605 }
3606
3607 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3608 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3609 if (in_fp == 0)
3610 ;
3611 else if (out_fp == 0)
3612 {
3613 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3614 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3615 last_ld = ibfd;
3616 }
3617 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3618 {
3619 _bfd_error_handler
3620 /* xgettext:c-format */
3621 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3622 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3623 ret = FALSE;
3624 }
3625 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3626 {
3627 _bfd_error_handler
3628 /* xgettext:c-format */
3629 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3630 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3631 ret = FALSE;
3632 }
3633 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3634 {
3635 _bfd_error_handler
3636 /* xgettext:c-format */
3637 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3638 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3639 ret = FALSE;
3640 }
3641 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3642 {
3643 _bfd_error_handler
3644 /* xgettext:c-format */
3645 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3646 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3647 ret = FALSE;
3648 }
3649 }
3650
3651 if (!ret)
3652 {
3653 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3654 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3655 }
3656 return ret;
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3660 there are conflicting attributes. */
3661 static bfd_boolean
3662 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3663 {
3664 bfd *obfd;
3665 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3666 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3667 bfd_boolean ret;
3668
3669 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3670 return FALSE;
3671
3672 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3673 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3674 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3675
3676 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3677 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3678 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3679 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3680 ret = TRUE;
3681 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3682 {
3683 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3684 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3685 static bfd *last_vec;
3686
3687 if (in_vec == 0)
3688 ;
3689 else if (out_vec == 0)
3690 {
3691 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3692 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3693 last_vec = ibfd;
3694 }
3695 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3696 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3697 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3698 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3699 case too. */
3700 else if (in_vec == 1)
3701 ;
3702 else if (out_vec == 1)
3703 {
3704 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3705 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3706 last_vec = ibfd;
3707 }
3708 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3709 {
3710 _bfd_error_handler
3711 /* xgettext:c-format */
3712 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3713 last_vec, ibfd);
3714 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3715 ret = FALSE;
3716 }
3717 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3718 {
3719 _bfd_error_handler
3720 /* xgettext:c-format */
3721 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3722 ibfd, last_vec);
3723 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3724 ret = FALSE;
3725 }
3726 }
3727
3728 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3729 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3730 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3731 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3732 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3733 {
3734 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3735 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3736 static bfd *last_struct;
3737
3738 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3739 ;
3740 else if (out_struct == 0)
3741 {
3742 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3743 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3744 last_struct = ibfd;
3745 }
3746 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3747 {
3748 _bfd_error_handler
3749 /* xgettext:c-format */
3750 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3751 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3752 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3753 ret = FALSE;
3754 }
3755 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3756 {
3757 _bfd_error_handler
3758 /* xgettext:c-format */
3759 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3760 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3761 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3762 ret = FALSE;
3763 }
3764 }
3765 if (!ret)
3766 {
3767 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3768 return FALSE;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3772 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3773 }
3774
3775 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3776 object file when linking. */
3777
3778 static bfd_boolean
3779 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3780 {
3781 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3782 flagword old_flags;
3783 flagword new_flags;
3784 bfd_boolean error;
3785
3786 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3787 return TRUE;
3788
3789 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3790 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3791 return FALSE;
3792
3793 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3794 return FALSE;
3795
3796 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3797 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3798 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3799 {
3800 /* First call, no flags set. */
3801 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3802 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3803 }
3804
3805 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3806 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3807 ;
3808
3809 /* Incompatible flags. */
3810 else
3811 {
3812 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3813 to be linked with either. */
3814 error = FALSE;
3815 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3816 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3817 {
3818 error = TRUE;
3819 _bfd_error_handler
3820 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3821 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3822 }
3823 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3824 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3825 {
3826 error = TRUE;
3827 _bfd_error_handler
3828 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3829 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3830 }
3831
3832 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3833 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3834 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3835
3836 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3837 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3838 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3839 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3840 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3841 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3842
3843 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3844 any module uses it. */
3845 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3846
3847 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3848 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3849
3850 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3851 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3852 {
3853 error = TRUE;
3854 _bfd_error_handler
3855 /* xgettext:c-format */
3856 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3857 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3858 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3859 }
3860
3861 if (error)
3862 {
3863 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3864 return FALSE;
3865 }
3866 }
3867
3868 return TRUE;
3869 }
3870
3871 static void
3872 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3873 asection *input_section,
3874 unsigned long offset,
3875 bfd_byte *loc,
3876 bfd_vma value,
3877 split16_format_type split16_format,
3878 bfd_boolean fixup)
3879 {
3880 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3881
3882 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3883 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3884 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3885 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3886 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3887 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3888 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3889 {
3890 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3891 {
3892 if (fixup)
3893 split16_format = split16a_type;
3894 else
3895 _bfd_error_handler
3896 /* xgettext:c-format */
3897 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3898 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3899 }
3900 }
3901 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3902 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3903 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3904 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3905 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3906 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3907 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3908 {
3909 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3910 {
3911 if (fixup)
3912 split16_format = split16d_type;
3913 else
3914 _bfd_error_handler
3915 /* xgettext:c-format */
3916 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3917 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3918 }
3919 }
3920 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3921 {
3922 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3923 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3924 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3925 {
3926 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3927 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3928 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3929 }
3930 }
3931 else
3932 {
3933 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3934 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3935 }
3936 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3937 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3938 }
3939
3940 static void
3941 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3942 {
3943 unsigned int insn;
3944
3945 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3946 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3947 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3948 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3949 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3950 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3951 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3952 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3953 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3954 }
3955
3956 \f
3957 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3958 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3959 int
3960 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3961 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3962 {
3963 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3964 flagword flags;
3965
3966 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3967
3968 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3969 {
3970 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3971
3972 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3973 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3974 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3975 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3976 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3977 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3978 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3979 || h->needs_plt)
3980 && h->ref_regular
3981 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3982 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3983 {
3984 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3985 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3986 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3987 r30 to be set up. */
3988 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3989 }
3990 else
3991 {
3992 bfd *ibfd;
3993 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3994
3995 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3996 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
3997 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
3998 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
3999 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4000 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4001 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4002 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4003 {
4004 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4005 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4006 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4007 {
4008 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4009 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4010 break;
4011 }
4012 }
4013 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4014 }
4015 }
4016 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4017 {
4018 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4019 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4020 else
4021 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4022 }
4023
4024 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4025
4026 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4027 {
4028 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4029 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4030
4031 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4032 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4033 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4034 return -1;
4035
4036 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4037 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4038 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4039 return -1;
4040 }
4041 else
4042 {
4043 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4044 if (htab->glink != NULL
4045 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4046 return -1;
4047 }
4048 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4049 }
4050 \f
4051 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4052 relocation. */
4053
4054 static asection *
4055 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4056 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4057 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4058 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4059 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4060 {
4061 if (h != NULL)
4062 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4063 {
4064 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4065 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4066 return NULL;
4067 }
4068
4069 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4070 }
4071
4072 static bfd_boolean
4073 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4074 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4075 asection **symsecp,
4076 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4077 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4078 unsigned long r_symndx,
4079 bfd *ibfd)
4080 {
4081 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4082
4083 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4084 {
4085 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4086 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4087
4088 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4089 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4090 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4091 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4092
4093 if (hp != NULL)
4094 *hp = h;
4095
4096 if (symp != NULL)
4097 *symp = NULL;
4098
4099 if (symsecp != NULL)
4100 {
4101 asection *symsec = NULL;
4102 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4103 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4104 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4105 *symsecp = symsec;
4106 }
4107
4108 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4109 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4110 }
4111 else
4112 {
4113 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4114 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4115
4116 if (locsyms == NULL)
4117 {
4118 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4119 if (locsyms == NULL)
4120 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4121 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4122 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4123 if (locsyms == NULL)
4124 return FALSE;
4125 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4126 }
4127 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4128
4129 if (hp != NULL)
4130 *hp = NULL;
4131
4132 if (symp != NULL)
4133 *symp = sym;
4134
4135 if (symsecp != NULL)
4136 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4137
4138 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4139 {
4140 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4141 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4142
4143 tls_mask = NULL;
4144 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4145 if (local_got != NULL)
4146 {
4147 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4148 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4149 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4150 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4151 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4152 }
4153 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4154 }
4155 }
4156 return TRUE;
4157 }
4158 \f
4159 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4160 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4161
4162 bfd_boolean
4163 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4164 {
4165 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4166 bfd *ibfd;
4167 asection *sec;
4168 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4169
4170 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4171 if (htab == NULL)
4172 return FALSE;
4173
4174 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4175 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4176 between the call and its destination. */
4177 limit = 0x1e00000;
4178 low_vma = -1;
4179 high_vma = 0;
4180 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4181 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4182 {
4183 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4184 low_vma = sec->vma;
4185 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4186 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4187 }
4188
4189 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4190 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4191 is local. */
4192 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4193 {
4194 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4195 return TRUE;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4199 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4200 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4201 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4202 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4203 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4204 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4205 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4206 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4207 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4208 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4209 together except their symbol. */
4210
4211 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4212 {
4213 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4214 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4215
4216 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4217 continue;
4218
4219 local_syms = NULL;
4220 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4221
4222 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4223 if (sec->has_pltcall
4224 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4225 {
4226 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4227
4228 /* Read the relocations. */
4229 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4230 info->keep_memory);
4231 if (relstart == NULL)
4232 return FALSE;
4233
4234 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4235 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4236 {
4237 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4238 unsigned long r_symndx;
4239 asection *sym_sec;
4240 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4241 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4242 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4243
4244 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4245 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4246 continue;
4247
4248 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4249 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4250 r_symndx, ibfd))
4251 {
4252 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4253 free (relstart);
4254 if (local_syms != NULL
4255 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4256 free (local_syms);
4257 return FALSE;
4258 }
4259
4260 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4261 {
4262 bfd_vma from, to;
4263 if (h != NULL)
4264 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4265 else
4266 to = sym->st_value;
4267 to += (rel->r_addend
4268 + sym_sec->output_offset
4269 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4270 from = (rel->r_offset
4271 + sec->output_offset
4272 + sec->output_section->vma);
4273 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4274 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4275 }
4276 }
4277 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4278 free (relstart);
4279 }
4280
4281 if (local_syms != NULL
4282 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4283 {
4284 if (!info->keep_memory)
4285 free (local_syms);
4286 else
4287 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4288 }
4289 }
4290
4291 return TRUE;
4292 }
4293
4294 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4295 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4296
4297 asection *
4298 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4299 {
4300 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4301
4302 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4303 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4304 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4305 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4306 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4307
4308 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4309 {
4310 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4311 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4312 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4313 if (opt != NULL
4314 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4315 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4316 {
4317 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4318 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4319 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4320 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4321 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4322 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4323 && tga != NULL
4324 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4325 || tga->needs_plt)
4326 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4327 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4328 {
4329 struct plt_entry *ent;
4330 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4331 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4332 break;
4333 if (ent != NULL)
4334 {
4335 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4336 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4337 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4338 opt->mark = 1;
4339 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4340 {
4341 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4342 opt->dynindx = -1;
4343 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4344 opt->dynstr_index);
4345 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4346 return FALSE;
4347 }
4348 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4349 }
4350 }
4351 }
4352 else
4353 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4354 }
4355 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4356 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4357 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4358 {
4359 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4360 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4361 }
4362
4363 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4364 }
4365
4366 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4367 HASH. */
4368
4369 static bfd_boolean
4370 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4371 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4372 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4373 {
4374 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4375 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4376 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4377
4378 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4379 {
4380 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4381 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4382
4383 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4384 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4385 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4386 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4387 if (h == hash)
4388 return TRUE;
4389 }
4390 return FALSE;
4391 }
4392
4393 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4394 opportunities. */
4395
4396 bfd_boolean
4397 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4398 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4399 {
4400 bfd *ibfd;
4401 asection *sec;
4402 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4403 int pass;
4404
4405 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4406 return TRUE;
4407
4408 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4409 if (htab == NULL)
4410 return FALSE;
4411
4412 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4413 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4414 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4415 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4416 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4417 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4418 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4419 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4420 {
4421 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4422 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4423
4424 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4425 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4426 {
4427 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4428 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4429
4430 /* Read the relocations. */
4431 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4432 info->keep_memory);
4433 if (relstart == NULL)
4434 return FALSE;
4435
4436 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4437 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4438 {
4439 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4440 unsigned long r_symndx;
4441 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4442 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4443 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4444 bfd_boolean is_local;
4445 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4446
4447 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4448 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4449 {
4450 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4451
4452 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4453 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4454 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4455 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4456 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4457 }
4458
4459 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4460 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4461 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4462 without marker relocs, then check that each
4463 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4464 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4465 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4466 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4467 if (pass == 0
4468 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4469 && h != NULL
4470 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4471 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4472 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4473 {
4474 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4475 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4476 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4477 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4478 free (relstart);
4479 return TRUE;
4480 }
4481
4482 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4483 switch (r_type)
4484 {
4485 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4486 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4487 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4488 /* Fall through. */
4489
4490 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4491 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4492 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4493 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4494 that turns out to be the case. */
4495 if (!is_local)
4496 continue;
4497
4498 /* LD -> LE */
4499 tls_set = 0;
4500 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4501 break;
4502
4503 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4504 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4505 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4506 /* Fall through. */
4507
4508 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4509 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4510 if (is_local)
4511 /* GD -> LE */
4512 tls_set = 0;
4513 else
4514 /* GD -> IE */
4515 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4516 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4517 break;
4518
4519 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4520 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4521 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4523 if (is_local)
4524 {
4525 /* IE -> LE */
4526 tls_set = 0;
4527 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4528 break;
4529 }
4530 else
4531 continue;
4532
4533 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4534 if (!is_local)
4535 continue;
4536 /* Fall through. */
4537 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4538 if (rel + 1 < relend
4539 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4540 {
4541 if (pass != 0
4542 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4543 {
4544 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4545 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4546 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4547 {
4548 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4549
4550 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4551 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4552 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4553 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4554 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4555 if (h != NULL)
4556 {
4557 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4558 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4559
4560 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4561 addend = rel->r_addend;
4562 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4563 got2, addend);
4564 if (ent != NULL
4565 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4566 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4567 }
4568 }
4569 }
4570 continue;
4571 }
4572 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4573 tls_set = 0;
4574 tls_clear = 0;
4575 break;
4576
4577 default:
4578 continue;
4579 }
4580
4581 if (pass == 0)
4582 {
4583 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4584 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4585 continue;
4586
4587 if (rel + 1 < relend
4588 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4589 htab->tls_get_addr))
4590 continue;
4591
4592 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4593 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4594 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4595 the entire optimization. */
4596 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4597 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4598 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4599 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4600 free (relstart);
4601 return TRUE;
4602 }
4603
4604 if (h != NULL)
4605 {
4606 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4607 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4608 }
4609 else
4610 {
4611 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4612 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4613 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4614
4615 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4616 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4617 abort ();
4618 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4619 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4620 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4621 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4622 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4623 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4624 }
4625
4626 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4627 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4628 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4629 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4630 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4631 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4632 Disable optimization in this case. */
4633 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4634 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4635 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4636 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4637 continue;
4638
4639 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4640 {
4641 struct plt_entry *ent;
4642 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4643
4644 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4645 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4646 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4647 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4648 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4649 got2, addend);
4650 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4651 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4652 }
4653 if (tls_clear == 0)
4654 continue;
4655
4656 if (tls_set == 0)
4657 {
4658 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4659 if (*got_count > 0)
4660 *got_count -= 1;
4661 }
4662
4663 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4664 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4665 }
4666
4667 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4668 free (relstart);
4669 }
4670 }
4671 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4672 return TRUE;
4673 }
4674 \f
4675 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4676
4677 static asection *
4678 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4679 {
4680 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4681
4682 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4683 {
4684 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4685
4686 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4687 return p->sec;
4688 }
4689 return NULL;
4690 }
4691
4692 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4693 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4694 size_dynamic_sections. */
4695
4696 static bfd_boolean
4697 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4698 {
4699 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4700 do
4701 {
4702 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4703 return TRUE;
4704 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4705 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4706
4707 return FALSE;
4708 }
4709
4710 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4711
4712 static bfd_boolean
4713 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4714 {
4715 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4716
4717 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4718 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4719 return TRUE;
4720 return FALSE;
4721 }
4722
4723 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4724 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4725 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4726 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4727 understand. */
4728
4729 static bfd_boolean
4730 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4731 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4732 {
4733 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4734 asection *s;
4735
4736 #ifdef DEBUG
4737 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4738 h->root.root.string);
4739 #endif
4740
4741 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4742 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4743 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4744 && (h->needs_plt
4745 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4746 || h->is_weakalias
4747 || (h->def_dynamic
4748 && h->ref_regular
4749 && !h->def_regular)));
4750
4751 /* Deal with function syms. */
4752 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4753 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4754 || h->needs_plt)
4755 {
4756 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4757 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4758 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4759 function symbol is local. */
4760 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4761 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4762
4763 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4764 won't need a .plt entry. */
4765 struct plt_entry *ent;
4766 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4767 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4768 break;
4769 if (ent == NULL
4770 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4771 && local
4772 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4773 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4774 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4775 {
4776 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4777
4778 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4779 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4780 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4781
4782 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4783
4784 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4785 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4786 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4787 h->needs_plt = 0;
4788 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4789 }
4790 else
4791 {
4792 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4793 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4794 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4795 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4796 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4797 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4798 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4799 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4800 than link time. */
4801 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4802 || (h->non_got_ref
4803 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4804 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4805 && !htab->is_vxworks
4806 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4807 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4808 {
4809 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4810 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4811 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4812 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4813 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4814 }
4815 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4816 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4817 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4818 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4819 }
4820 h->protected_def = 0;
4821 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4822 return TRUE;
4823 }
4824 else
4825 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4826
4827 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4828 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4829 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4830 if (h->is_weakalias)
4831 {
4832 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4833 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4834 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4835 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4836 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4837 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4838 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4839 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4840 return TRUE;
4841 }
4842
4843 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4844 is not a function. */
4845
4846 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4847 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4848 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4849 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4850 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4851 {
4852 h->protected_def = 0;
4853 return TRUE;
4854 }
4855
4856 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4857 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4858 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4859 {
4860 h->protected_def = 0;
4861 return TRUE;
4862 }
4863
4864 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4865 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4866 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4867 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4868 if (h->protected_def)
4869 {
4870 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4871 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4872 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4873 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4874 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4875 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4876 return TRUE;
4877 }
4878
4879 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4880 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4881 return TRUE;
4882
4883 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4884 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4885 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4886 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4887 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4888 executable. */
4889 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4890 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4891 && !htab->is_vxworks
4892 && !h->def_regular
4893 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4894 return TRUE;
4895
4896 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4897 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4898 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4899 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4900 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4901 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4902 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4903 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4904 same memory location for the variable.
4905
4906 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4907 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4908 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4909 s = htab->dynsbss;
4910 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4911 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4912 else
4913 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4914 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4915
4916 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4917 {
4918 asection *srel;
4919
4920 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4921 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4922 and into the runtime process image. */
4923 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4924 srel = htab->relsbss;
4925 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4926 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4927 else
4928 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4929 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4930 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4931 h->needs_copy = 1;
4932 }
4933
4934 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4935 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4936 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4937 }
4938 \f
4939 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4940 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4941 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4942 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4943 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4944
4945 static bfd_boolean
4946 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4947 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4948 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4949 {
4950 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4951 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4952 char *name;
4953 const char *stub;
4954 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4955
4956 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4957 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4958 else
4959 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4960
4961 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4962 len2 = strlen (stub);
4963 len3 = 0;
4964 if (ent->sec)
4965 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4966 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4967 if (name == NULL)
4968 return FALSE;
4969 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4970 if (ent->sec)
4971 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4972 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4973 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4974 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4975 if (sh == NULL)
4976 return FALSE;
4977 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4978 {
4979 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4980 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4981 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4982 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4983 sh->def_regular = 1;
4984 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4985 sh->forced_local = 1;
4986 sh->non_elf = 0;
4987 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4988 }
4989 return TRUE;
4990 }
4991
4992 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4993 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4994
4995 static bfd_vma
4996 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
4997 {
4998 bfd_vma where;
4999 unsigned int max_before_header;
5000
5001 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5002 {
5003 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5004 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5005 }
5006 else
5007 {
5008 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5009 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5010 {
5011 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5012 htab->got_gap -= need;
5013 }
5014 else
5015 {
5016 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5017 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5018 {
5019 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5020 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5021 }
5022 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5023 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5024 }
5025 }
5026 return where;
5027 }
5028
5029 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5030 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5031
5032 static inline unsigned int
5033 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5034 {
5035 unsigned int need;
5036 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5037 need = 4;
5038 else
5039 {
5040 need = 0;
5041 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5042 need += 8;
5043 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5044 need += 4;
5045 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5046 need += 4;
5047 }
5048 return need;
5049 }
5050
5051 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5052
5053 static bfd_boolean
5054 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5055 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5056 {
5057 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5058
5059 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5060 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5061 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5062 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5063 && h->dynindx == -1
5064 && !h->forced_local
5065 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5066 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5067 return TRUE;
5068 }
5069
5070 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5071
5072 static bfd_boolean
5073 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5074 {
5075 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5076 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5077 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5078 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5079 bfd_boolean dyn;
5080
5081 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5082 return TRUE;
5083
5084 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5085 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5086 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5087 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5088 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5089 && eh->elf.protected_def
5090 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5091 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5092 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5093 {
5094 unsigned int need;
5095
5096 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5097 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5098 return FALSE;
5099
5100 need = 0;
5101 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5102 {
5103 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5104 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5105 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5106 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5107 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5108 else
5109 need += 8;
5110 }
5111 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5112 if (need == 0)
5113 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5114 else
5115 {
5116 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5117 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5118 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5119 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5120 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5121 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5122 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5123 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5124 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5125 {
5126 asection *rsec;
5127
5128 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5129 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5130 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5131 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5132 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5133 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5134 rsec->size += need;
5135 }
5136 }
5137 }
5138 else
5139 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5140
5141 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5142 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5143 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5144 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5145 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5146
5147 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5148 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5149 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5150 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5151
5152 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5153 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5154 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5155 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5156
5157 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5158 ;
5159
5160 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5161 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5162 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5163 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5164 changes. */
5165 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5166 {
5167 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5168 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5169 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5170 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5171 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5172 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5173 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5174 {
5175 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5176
5177 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5178 {
5179 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5180 p->pc_count = 0;
5181 if (p->count == 0)
5182 *pp = p->next;
5183 else
5184 pp = &p->next;
5185 }
5186 }
5187
5188 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5189 {
5190 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5191
5192 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5193 {
5194 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5195 *pp = p->next;
5196 else
5197 pp = &p->next;
5198 }
5199 }
5200
5201 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5202 {
5203 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5204 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5205 return FALSE;
5206 }
5207 }
5208 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5209 {
5210 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5211 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5212 dynamic. */
5213 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5214 && !h->def_regular
5215 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5216 && !(h->protected_def
5217 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5218 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5219 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5220 {
5221 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5222 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5223 return FALSE;
5224
5225 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5226 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5227 }
5228 else
5229 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Allocate space. */
5233 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5234 {
5235 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5236 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5237 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5238 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5239 }
5240
5241 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5242 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5243 a) is dynamic, or
5244 b) is an ifunc, or
5245 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5246 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5247 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5248 if (dyn
5249 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5250 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5251 || (h->needs_plt
5252 && h->def_regular
5253 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5254 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5255 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5256 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5257 {
5258 struct plt_entry *ent;
5259 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5260 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5261
5262 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5263 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5264 {
5265 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5266
5267 if (!dyn)
5268 {
5269 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5270 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5271 else
5272 s = htab->pltlocal;
5273 }
5274
5275 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5276 {
5277 if (!doneone)
5278 {
5279 plt_offset = s->size;
5280 s->size += 4;
5281 }
5282 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5283
5284 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5285 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5286 else
5287 {
5288 s = htab->glink;
5289 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5290 {
5291 glink_offset = s->size;
5292 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5293 }
5294 if (!doneone
5295 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5296 && h->def_dynamic
5297 && !h->def_regular)
5298 {
5299 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5300 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5301 }
5302 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5303
5304 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5305 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5306 return FALSE;
5307 }
5308 }
5309 else
5310 {
5311 if (!doneone)
5312 {
5313 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5314 for the special first entry. */
5315 if (s->size == 0)
5316 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5317
5318 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5319 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5320 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5321 word available at the end. */
5322 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5323 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5324 * ((s->size
5325 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5326 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5327
5328 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5329 file, and we are not generating a shared
5330 library, then set the symbol to this location
5331 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5332 relocations, and is required to make
5333 function pointers compare as equal between
5334 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5335 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5336 && h->def_dynamic
5337 && !h->def_regular)
5338 {
5339 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5340 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5341 }
5342
5343 /* Make room for this entry. */
5344 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5345 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5346 is allocated. */
5347 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5348 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5349 / htab->plt_entry_size
5350 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5351 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5352 }
5353 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5354 }
5355
5356 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5357 if (!doneone)
5358 {
5359 if (!dyn)
5360 {
5361 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5362 {
5363 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5364 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5365 }
5366 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5367 {
5368 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5369 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5370 }
5371 }
5372 else
5373 {
5374 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5375
5376 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5377 {
5378 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5379 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5380 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5381 {
5382 if (ent->plt.offset
5383 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5384 {
5385 htab->srelplt2->size
5386 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5387 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5388 }
5389
5390 htab->srelplt2->size
5391 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5392 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5393 }
5394
5395 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5396 .got.plt. */
5397 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5398 }
5399 }
5400 doneone = TRUE;
5401 }
5402 }
5403 else
5404 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5405
5406 if (!doneone)
5407 {
5408 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5409 h->needs_plt = 0;
5410 }
5411 }
5412 else
5413 {
5414 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5415 h->needs_plt = 0;
5416 }
5417
5418 return TRUE;
5419 }
5420
5421 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5422 read-only sections. */
5423
5424 static bfd_boolean
5425 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5426 {
5427 asection *sec;
5428
5429 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5430 return TRUE;
5431
5432 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5433 if (sec != NULL)
5434 {
5435 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5436
5437 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5438 info->callbacks->minfo
5439 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5440 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5441
5442 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5443 return FALSE;
5444 }
5445 return TRUE;
5446 }
5447
5448 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5449 {
5450 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5451 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5452 1, /* CIE version. */
5453 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5454 4, /* Code alignment. */
5455 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5456 65, /* RA reg. */
5457 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5458 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5459 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5460 };
5461
5462 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5463
5464 static bfd_boolean
5465 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5466 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5467 {
5468 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5469 asection *s;
5470 bfd_boolean relocs;
5471 bfd *ibfd;
5472
5473 #ifdef DEBUG
5474 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5475 #endif
5476
5477 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5478 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5479
5480 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5481 {
5482 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5483 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5484 {
5485 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5486 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5487 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5488 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5489 }
5490 }
5491
5492 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5493 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5494 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5495 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5496
5497 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5498 relocs. */
5499 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5500 {
5501 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5502 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5503 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5504 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5505 char *lgot_masks;
5506 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5507 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5508
5509 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5510 continue;
5511
5512 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5513 {
5514 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5515
5516 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5517 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5518 p != NULL;
5519 p = p->next)
5520 {
5521 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5522 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5523 {
5524 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5525 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5526 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5527 the relocs too. */
5528 }
5529 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5530 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5531 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5532 {
5533 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5534 handled specially by the loader. */
5535 }
5536 else if (p->count != 0)
5537 {
5538 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5539 if (p->ifunc)
5540 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5541 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5542 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5543 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5544 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5545 {
5546 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5547 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5548 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5549 }
5550 }
5551 }
5552 }
5553
5554 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5555 if (!local_got)
5556 continue;
5557
5558 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5559 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5560 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5561 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5562 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5563 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5564
5565 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5566 if (*local_got > 0)
5567 {
5568 unsigned int need;
5569 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5570 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5571 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5572 if (need == 0)
5573 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5574 else
5575 {
5576 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5577 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5578 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5579 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5580 {
5581 asection *srel;
5582
5583 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5584 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5585 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5586 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5587 srel->size += need;
5588 }
5589 }
5590 }
5591 else
5592 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5593
5594 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5595 continue;
5596
5597 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5598 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5599 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5600 {
5601 struct plt_entry *ent;
5602 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5603 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5604
5605 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5606 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5607 {
5608 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5609 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5610 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5611 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5612 {
5613 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5614 continue;
5615 }
5616 else
5617 s = htab->pltlocal;
5618
5619 if (!doneone)
5620 {
5621 plt_offset = s->size;
5622 s->size += 4;
5623 }
5624 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5625
5626 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5627 {
5628 s = htab->glink;
5629 glink_offset = s->size;
5630 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5631 }
5632 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5633
5634 if (!doneone)
5635 {
5636 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5637 {
5638 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5639 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5640 }
5641 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5642 {
5643 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5644 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5645 }
5646 doneone = TRUE;
5647 }
5648 }
5649 else
5650 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5651 }
5652 }
5653
5654 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5655 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5656
5657 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5658 {
5659 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5660 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5661 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5662 }
5663 else
5664 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5665
5666 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5667 {
5668 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5669
5670 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5671 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5672 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5673 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5674 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5675 {
5676 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5677 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5678 g_o_t += 4;
5679 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5680 }
5681
5682 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5683 }
5684 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5685 {
5686 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5687
5688 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5689 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5690 }
5691 if (info->emitrelocations)
5692 {
5693 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5694
5695 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5696 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5697 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5698 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5699 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5700 }
5701
5702 if (htab->glink != NULL
5703 && htab->glink->size != 0
5704 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5705 {
5706 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5707 /* Space for the branch table. */
5708 htab->glink->size
5709 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5710 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5711 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5712 ? 63 : 15);
5713 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5714
5715 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5716 {
5717 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5718 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5719 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5720 if (sh == NULL)
5721 return FALSE;
5722 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5723 {
5724 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5725 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5726 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5727 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5728 sh->def_regular = 1;
5729 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5730 sh->forced_local = 1;
5731 sh->non_elf = 0;
5732 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5733 }
5734 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5735 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5736 if (sh == NULL)
5737 return FALSE;
5738 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5739 {
5740 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5741 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5742 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5743 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5744 sh->def_regular = 1;
5745 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5746 sh->forced_local = 1;
5747 sh->non_elf = 0;
5748 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5749 }
5750 }
5751 }
5752
5753 if (htab->glink != NULL
5754 && htab->glink->size != 0
5755 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5756 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5757 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5758 {
5759 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5760 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5761 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5762 {
5763 s->size += 4;
5764 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5765 s->size += 4;
5766 }
5767 }
5768
5769 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5770 Allocate memory for them. */
5771 relocs = FALSE;
5772 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5773 {
5774 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5775
5776 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5777 continue;
5778
5779 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5780 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5781 {
5782 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5783 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5784 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5785 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5786 strip_section = FALSE;
5787 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5788 comment below. */
5789 }
5790 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5791 || s == htab->pltlocal
5792 || s == htab->glink
5793 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5794 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5795 || s == htab->sbss
5796 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5797 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5798 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5799 {
5800 /* Strip these too. */
5801 }
5802 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5803 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5804 {
5805 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5806 }
5807 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5808 {
5809 if (s->size != 0)
5810 {
5811 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5812 relocs = TRUE;
5813
5814 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5815 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5816 s->reloc_count = 0;
5817 }
5818 }
5819 else
5820 {
5821 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5822 continue;
5823 }
5824
5825 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5826 {
5827 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5828 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5829 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5830 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5831 before the linker maps input sections to output
5832 sections. The linker does that before
5833 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5834 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5835 into these sections. */
5836 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5837 continue;
5838 }
5839
5840 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5841 continue;
5842
5843 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5844 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5845 if (s->contents == NULL)
5846 return FALSE;
5847 }
5848
5849 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5850 {
5851 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5852 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5853 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5854 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5855 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5856 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5857 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5858
5859 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5860 {
5861 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5862 return FALSE;
5863 }
5864
5865 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5866 {
5867 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5868 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5869 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5870 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5871 return FALSE;
5872 }
5873
5874 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5875 && htab->glink != NULL
5876 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5877 {
5878 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5879 return FALSE;
5880 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5881 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5882 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5883 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5884 return FALSE;
5885 }
5886
5887 if (relocs)
5888 {
5889 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5890 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5891 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5892 return FALSE;
5893 }
5894
5895 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5896 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5897 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5898 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5899 info);
5900
5901 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5902 {
5903 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5904 return FALSE;
5905 }
5906 if (htab->is_vxworks
5907 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5908 return FALSE;
5909 }
5910 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5911
5912 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5913 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5914 {
5915 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5916 bfd_vma val;
5917
5918 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5919 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5920 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5921 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5922 /* FDE length. */
5923 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5924 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5925 p += 4;
5926 /* CIE pointer. */
5927 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5928 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5929 p += 4;
5930 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5931 p += 4;
5932 /* .glink size. */
5933 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5934 p += 4;
5935 /* Augmentation. */
5936 p += 1;
5937
5938 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5939 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5940 {
5941 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5942 if (adv < 64)
5943 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5944 else if (adv < 256)
5945 {
5946 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5947 *p++ = adv;
5948 }
5949 else if (adv < 65536)
5950 {
5951 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5952 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5953 p += 2;
5954 }
5955 else
5956 {
5957 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5958 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5959 p += 4;
5960 }
5961 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5962 *p++ = 65;
5963 p++;
5964 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5965 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5966 *p++ = 65;
5967 }
5968 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5969 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5970 }
5971
5972 return TRUE;
5973 }
5974
5975 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5976 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5977
5978 static void
5979 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5980 {
5981 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5982
5983 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5984 {
5985 asection *s;
5986
5987 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5988 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5989 {
5990 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5991 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5992 {
5993 sda->def_regular = 0;
5994 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5995 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5996 sda->forced_local = 0;
5997 }
5998 }
5999 }
6000 }
6001
6002 void
6003 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6004 {
6005 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6006
6007 if (htab != NULL)
6008 {
6009 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6010 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6011 }
6012 }
6013
6014
6015 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6016
6017 static bfd_boolean
6018 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6019 {
6020 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6021 && !h->def_regular
6022 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6023 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6024 return FALSE;
6025
6026 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6027 }
6028 \f
6029 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6030
6031 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6032 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6033 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6034 {
6035 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6036 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6037 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6038 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6039 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6040 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6041 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6042 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6043 };
6044
6045 static const int stub_entry[] =
6046 {
6047 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6048 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6049 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6050 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6051 };
6052
6053 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6054 {
6055 unsigned int workaround_size;
6056 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6057 };
6058
6059 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6060 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6061 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6062 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6063
6064 static bfd_boolean
6065 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6066 asection *isec,
6067 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6068 bfd_boolean *again)
6069 {
6070 struct one_branch_fixup
6071 {
6072 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6073 asection *tsec;
6074 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6075 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6076 bfd_vma toff;
6077 bfd_vma trampoff;
6078 };
6079
6080 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6081 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6082 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6083 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6084 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6085 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6086 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6087 unsigned changes = 0;
6088 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6089 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6090 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6091 asection *got2;
6092 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6093
6094 *again = FALSE;
6095
6096 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6097 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6098 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6099 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6100 || isec->size < 4)
6101 return TRUE;
6102
6103 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6104 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6105 anyway. */
6106 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6107 return TRUE;
6108
6109 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6110 if (htab == NULL)
6111 return TRUE;
6112
6113 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6114 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6115 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6116 trampbase = isec->size;
6117
6118 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6119 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6120 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6121
6122 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6123 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6124 {
6125 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6126 {
6127 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6128 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6129 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6130 return FALSE;
6131 }
6132 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6133 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6134 }
6135
6136 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6137 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6138 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6139 trampoff = trampbase;
6140 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6141 trampoff += 4;
6142
6143 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6144 picfixup_size = 0;
6145 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6146 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6147 {
6148 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6149 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6150 {
6151 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6152 link_info->keep_memory);
6153 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6154 goto error_return;
6155 }
6156
6157 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6158
6159 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6160 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6161 {
6162 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6163 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6164 asection *tsec;
6165 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6166 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6167 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6168 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6169 unsigned long t0;
6170 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6171 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6172 struct plt_entry **plist;
6173 unsigned char sym_type;
6174
6175 switch (r_type)
6176 {
6177 case R_PPC_REL24:
6178 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6179 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6180 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6181 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6182 break;
6183
6184 case R_PPC_REL14:
6185 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6186 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6187 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6188 break;
6189
6190 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6191 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6192 break;
6193 continue;
6194
6195 default:
6196 continue;
6197 }
6198
6199 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6200 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6201 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6202 goto error_return;
6203
6204 if (isym != NULL)
6205 {
6206 if (tsec != NULL)
6207 ;
6208 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6209 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6210 else
6211 continue;
6212
6213 toff = isym->st_value;
6214 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6215 }
6216 else
6217 {
6218 if (tsec != NULL)
6219 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6220 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6221 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6222 {
6223 unsigned long indx;
6224
6225 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6226 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6227 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6228 }
6229 else
6230 continue;
6231
6232 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6233 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6234 branch stub in that case. */
6235 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6236 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6237 && irel != internal_relocs)
6238 {
6239 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6240 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6241 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6242
6243 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6244 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6245 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6246 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6247 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6248 {
6249 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6250
6251 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6252 {
6253 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6254 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6255 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6256 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6257 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6258 }
6259 }
6260 else
6261 {
6262 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6263 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6264
6265 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6266 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6267 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6268
6269 tls_mask
6270 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6271 }
6272
6273 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6274 optimised away. */
6275 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6276 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6277 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6278 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6279 continue;
6280 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6281 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6282 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6283 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6284 continue;
6285 }
6286
6287 sym_type = h->type;
6288 }
6289
6290 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6291 {
6292 if (h != NULL
6293 && !h->def_regular
6294 && h->protected_def
6295 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6296 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6297 picfixup_size += 12;
6298 continue;
6299 }
6300
6301 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6302 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6303 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6304 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6305 plist = NULL;
6306 if (h != NULL)
6307 {
6308 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6309 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6310 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6311 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6312 }
6313 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6314 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6315 {
6316 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6317 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6318 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6319 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6320 }
6321 if (plist != NULL)
6322 {
6323 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6324 struct plt_entry *ent;
6325
6326 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6327 addend = irel->r_addend;
6328 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6329 if (ent != NULL)
6330 {
6331 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6332 || h == NULL
6333 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6334 || h->dynindx == -1)
6335 {
6336 tsec = htab->glink;
6337 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6338 }
6339 else
6340 {
6341 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6342 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6343 }
6344 }
6345 }
6346
6347 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6348 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6349 branch overflow. */
6350 if (tsec == isec)
6351 continue;
6352
6353 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6354 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6355 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6356 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6357 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6358 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6359 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6360 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6361 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6362 continue;
6363
6364 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6365 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6366 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6367 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6368 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6369 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6370 {
6371 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6372 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6373 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6374 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6375 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6376
6377 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6378 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6379 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6380 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6381 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6382 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6383 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6384 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6385 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6386 location of interest is just "sym". */
6387 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6388 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6389 toff += irel->r_addend;
6390
6391 toff
6392 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6393 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6394 toff);
6395
6396 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6397 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6398 toff += irel->r_addend;
6399 }
6400 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6401 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6402 toff += irel->r_addend;
6403
6404 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6405 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6406 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6407 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6408 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6409 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6410 continue;
6411
6412 roff = irel->r_offset;
6413
6414 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6415 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6416 fixup can be created at final link.
6417 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6418 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6419 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6420 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6421 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6422 continue;
6423
6424 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6425 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6426 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6427 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6428 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6429 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6430 {
6431 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6432
6433 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6434 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6435 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6436 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6437 continue;
6438 }
6439
6440 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6441 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6442 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6443 break;
6444
6445 if (f == NULL)
6446 {
6447 size_t size;
6448 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6449
6450 val = trampoff - roff;
6451 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6452 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6453 one. We'll report an error later. */
6454 continue;
6455
6456 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6457 {
6458 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6459 insn_offset = 12;
6460 }
6461 else
6462 {
6463 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6464 insn_offset = 0;
6465 }
6466 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6467 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6468 || tsec == htab->glink)
6469 {
6470 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6471 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6472 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6473 }
6474
6475 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6476 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6477 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6478 stub_rtype);
6479 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6480 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6481 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6482 irel->r_addend = 0;
6483
6484 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6485 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6486 f->next = branch_fixups;
6487 f->tsec = tsec;
6488 f->toff = toff;
6489 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6490 branch_fixups = f;
6491
6492 trampoff += size;
6493 changes++;
6494 }
6495 else
6496 {
6497 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6498 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6499 continue;
6500
6501 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6502 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6503 }
6504
6505 /* Get the section contents. */
6506 if (contents == NULL)
6507 {
6508 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6509 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6510 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6511 /* Go get them off disk. */
6512 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6513 goto error_return;
6514 }
6515
6516 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6517 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6518 switch (r_type)
6519 {
6520 case R_PPC_REL24:
6521 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6522 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6523 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6524 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6525 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6526 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6527 break;
6528
6529 case R_PPC_REL14:
6530 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6531 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6532 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6533 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6534 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6535 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6536 break;
6537 }
6538 }
6539
6540 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6541 {
6542 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6543 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6544 free (f);
6545 }
6546 }
6547
6548 workaround_change = FALSE;
6549 newsize = trampoff;
6550 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6551 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6552 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6553 {
6554 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6555 unsigned int crossings;
6556 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6557
6558 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6559 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6560 addr &= -pagesize;
6561 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6562 if (crossings != 0)
6563 {
6564 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6565 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6566 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6567 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6568 newsize += crossings * 16;
6569 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6570 {
6571 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6572 workaround_change = TRUE;
6573 }
6574 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6575 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6576 }
6577 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6578 }
6579
6580 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6581 {
6582 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6583 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6584 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6585 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6586 }
6587
6588 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6589 isec->size = newsize;
6590
6591 if (isymbuf != NULL
6592 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6593 {
6594 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6595 free (isymbuf);
6596 else
6597 {
6598 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6599 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6600 }
6601 }
6602
6603 if (contents != NULL
6604 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6605 {
6606 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6607 free (contents);
6608 else
6609 {
6610 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6611 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6612 }
6613 }
6614
6615 changes += picfixup_size;
6616 if (changes != 0)
6617 {
6618 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6619 information for the trampolines. */
6620 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6621 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6622 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6623 unsigned ix;
6624
6625 if (!new_relocs)
6626 goto error_return;
6627 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6628 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6629 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6630 {
6631 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6632
6633 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6634 }
6635 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6636 free (internal_relocs);
6637 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6638 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6639 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6640 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6641 }
6642 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6643 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6644 free (internal_relocs);
6645
6646 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6647 return TRUE;
6648
6649 error_return:
6650 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6651 {
6652 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6653 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6654 free (f);
6655 }
6656 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6657 free (isymbuf);
6658 if (contents != NULL
6659 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6660 free (contents);
6661 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6662 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6663 free (internal_relocs);
6664 return FALSE;
6665 }
6666 \f
6667 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6668 discarded sections. */
6669
6670 static unsigned int
6671 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6672 {
6673 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6674 return 0;
6675
6676 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6677 return 0;
6678
6679 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6680 }
6681 \f
6682 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6683
6684 static bfd_vma
6685 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6686 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6687 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6688 bfd_vma relocation,
6689 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6690 {
6691 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6692
6693 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6694
6695 if (h != NULL)
6696 {
6697 /* Handle global symbol. */
6698 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6699
6700 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6701 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6702 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6703 }
6704 else
6705 {
6706 /* Handle local symbol. */
6707 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6708
6709 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6710 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6711 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6712 }
6713
6714 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6715 rel->r_addend,
6716 lsect);
6717 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6718
6719 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6720 as a "written" flag. */
6721 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6722 {
6723 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6724 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6725 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6726 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6727 }
6728
6729 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6730 + lsect->section->output_offset
6731 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6732 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6733
6734 #ifdef DEBUG
6735 fprintf (stderr,
6736 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6737 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6738 #endif
6739
6740 return relocation;
6741 }
6742
6743 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6744 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6745 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6746
6747 static void
6748 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6749 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6750 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6751 {
6752 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6753 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6754 bfd_vma plt;
6755 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6756
6757 if (h != NULL
6758 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6759 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6760 {
6761 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6762 p += 4;
6763 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6764 p += 4;
6765 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6766 p += 4;
6767 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6768 p += 4;
6769 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6770 p += 4;
6771 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6772 p += 4;
6773 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6774 p += 4;
6775 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6776 p += 4;
6777 }
6778
6779 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6780 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6781 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6782
6783 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6784 {
6785 bfd_vma got = 0;
6786
6787 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6788 got = (ent->addend
6789 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6790 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6791 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6792 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6793
6794 plt -= got;
6795
6796 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6797 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6798 else
6799 {
6800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6801 p += 4;
6802 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6803 }
6804 }
6805 else
6806 {
6807 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6808 p += 4;
6809 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6810 }
6811 p += 4;
6812 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6813 p += 4;
6814 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6815 p += 4;
6816 while (p < end)
6817 {
6818 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6819 p += 4;
6820 }
6821 }
6822
6823 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6824
6825 static bfd_boolean
6826 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6827 {
6828 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6829 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6830 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6831 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6832 }
6833
6834 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6835 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6836 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6837
6838 unsigned int
6839 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6840 {
6841 unsigned int rtra;
6842
6843 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6844 return 0;
6845
6846 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6847 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6848 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6849 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6850 else
6851 return 0;
6852
6853 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6854 /* add -> addi. */
6855 insn = 14 << 26;
6856 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6857 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6858 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6859 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6860 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6861 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6862 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6863 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6864 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6865 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6866 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6867 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6868 else
6869 return 0;
6870 insn |= rtra;
6871 return insn;
6872 }
6873
6874 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6875 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6876 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6877
6878 unsigned int
6879 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6880 {
6881 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6882 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6883 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6884 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6885 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6886 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6887 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6888 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6889 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6890 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6891 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6892 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6893 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6894 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6895 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6896 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6897 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6898 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6899 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6900 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6901 {
6902 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6903 }
6904 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6905 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6906 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6907 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6908 {
6909 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6910 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6911 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6912 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6913 }
6914 else
6915 insn = 0;
6916 return insn;
6917 }
6918
6919 static bfd_boolean
6920 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6921 {
6922 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6923 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6924 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6925 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6926 }
6927
6928 static bfd_boolean
6929 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6930 {
6931 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6932 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6933 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6934 }
6935
6936 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6937 to handle the relocations for a section.
6938
6939 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6940 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6941 zero.
6942
6943 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6944 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6945 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6946 necessary.
6947
6948 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6949 address or the reloc symbol index.
6950
6951 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6952
6953 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6954 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6955
6956 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6957 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6958
6959 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6960 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6961 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6962 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6963 accordingly. */
6964
6965 static bfd_boolean
6966 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6967 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6968 bfd *input_bfd,
6969 asection *input_section,
6970 bfd_byte *contents,
6971 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6972 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6973 asection **local_sections)
6974 {
6975 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6976 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6977 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6978 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6979 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6980 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6981 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6982 asection *got2;
6983 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6984 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6985 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6986 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6987 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6988 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6989
6990 #ifdef DEBUG
6991 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6992 "%ld relocations%s",
6993 input_bfd, input_section,
6994 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6995 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6996 #endif
6997
6998 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6999 {
7000 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7001 return FALSE;
7002 }
7003
7004 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7005
7006 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7007 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7008 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7009
7010 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7011 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7012 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7013 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7014 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7015 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7016 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7017 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7018 ".tls_vars"));
7019 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7020 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7021 rel = wrel = relocs;
7022 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7023 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7024 {
7025 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7026 bfd_vma addend;
7027 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7028 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7029 asection *sec;
7030 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7031 const char *sym_name;
7032 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7033 unsigned long r_symndx;
7034 bfd_vma relocation;
7035 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7036 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7037 bfd_boolean warned;
7038 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7039 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7040 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7041
7042 again:
7043 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7044 sym = NULL;
7045 sec = NULL;
7046 h = NULL;
7047 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7048 warned = FALSE;
7049 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7050
7051 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7052 {
7053 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7054 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7055 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7056
7057 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7058 }
7059 else
7060 {
7061 bfd_boolean ignored;
7062
7063 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7064 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7065 h, sec, relocation,
7066 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7067
7068 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7069 }
7070
7071 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7072 {
7073 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7074 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7075 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7076 howto = NULL;
7077 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7078 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7079
7080 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7081 contents, rel->r_offset);
7082 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7083 wrel->r_info = 0;
7084 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7085
7086 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7087 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7088 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7089 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7090 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7091 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7092 wrel--;
7093
7094 continue;
7095 }
7096
7097 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7098 {
7099 if (got2 != NULL
7100 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7101 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7102 {
7103 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7104 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7105 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7106 }
7107 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7108 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7109 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7110 goto copy_reloc;
7111 }
7112
7113 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7114 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7115 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7116 for the final instruction stream. */
7117 tls_mask = 0;
7118 tls_gd = 0;
7119 if (h != NULL)
7120 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7121 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7122 {
7123 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7124 char *lgot_masks;
7125 local_plt
7126 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7127 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7128 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7129 }
7130
7131 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7132 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7133 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7134 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7135 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7136 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7137 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7138 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7139 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7140 abort ();
7141 switch (r_type)
7142 {
7143 default:
7144 break;
7145
7146 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7147 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7148 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7149 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7150 {
7151 bfd_vma insn;
7152
7153 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7154 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7155 insn &= 31 << 21;
7156 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7157 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7158 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7159 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7160 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7161 }
7162 break;
7163
7164 case R_PPC_TLS:
7165 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7166 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7167 {
7168 bfd_vma insn;
7169
7170 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7171 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7172 if (insn == 0)
7173 abort ();
7174 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7175 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7176 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7177
7178 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7179 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7180 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7181 }
7182 break;
7183
7184 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7185 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7186 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7187 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7188 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7189 break;
7190
7191 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7192 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7193 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7194 {
7195 tls_gdld_hi:
7196 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7197 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7198 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7199 else
7200 {
7201 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7202 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7203 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7204 }
7205 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7206 }
7207 break;
7208
7209 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7210 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7211 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7212 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7213 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7214 break;
7215
7216 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7217 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7218 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7219 {
7220 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7221 bfd_vma offset;
7222
7223 tls_ldgd_opt:
7224 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7225 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7226 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7227 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7228 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7229 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7230 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7231 && rel + 1 < relend
7232 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7233 htab->tls_get_addr))
7234 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7235 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7236 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7237 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7238 intervening code. */
7239 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7240 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7241 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7242 {
7243 /* IE */
7244 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7245 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7246 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7247 {
7248 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7249 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7250 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7251 }
7252 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7253 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7254 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7255 }
7256 else
7257 {
7258 /* LE */
7259 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7260 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7261 if (tls_gd == 0)
7262 {
7263 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7264 for (r_symndx = 0;
7265 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7266 r_symndx++)
7267 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7268 break;
7269 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7270 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7271 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7272 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7273 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7274 + sec->output_offset
7275 + sec->output_section->vma);
7276 }
7277 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7278 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7279 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7280 {
7281 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7282 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7283 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7284 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7285 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7286 }
7287 }
7288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7289 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7290 if (tls_gd == 0)
7291 {
7292 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7293 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7294 goto again;
7295 }
7296 }
7297 break;
7298
7299 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7300 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7301 && rel + 1 < relend)
7302 {
7303 unsigned int insn2;
7304 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7305
7306 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7307 {
7308 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7309 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7310 break;
7311 }
7312
7313 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7314 {
7315 /* IE */
7316 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7317 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7318 }
7319 else
7320 {
7321 /* LE */
7322 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7323 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7324 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7325 }
7326 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7327 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7328 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7329 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7330 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7331 }
7332 break;
7333
7334 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7335 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7336 && rel + 1 < relend)
7337 {
7338 unsigned int insn2;
7339
7340 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7341 {
7342 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7343 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7344 break;
7345 }
7346
7347 for (r_symndx = 0;
7348 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7349 r_symndx++)
7350 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7351 break;
7352 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7353 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7354 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7355 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7356 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7357 + sec->output_offset
7358 + sec->output_section->vma);
7359
7360 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7361 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7362 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7363 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7364 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7365 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7366 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7367 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7368 goto again;
7369 }
7370 break;
7371 }
7372
7373 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7374 branch_bit = 0;
7375 switch (r_type)
7376 {
7377 default:
7378 break;
7379
7380 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7381 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7382 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7383 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7384 /* Fall through. */
7385
7386 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7387 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7388 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7389 {
7390 unsigned int insn;
7391
7392 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7393 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7394 insn |= branch_bit;
7395
7396 from = (rel->r_offset
7397 + input_section->output_offset
7398 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7399
7400 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7401 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7402 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7403
7404 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7405 }
7406 break;
7407
7408 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7409 {
7410 unsigned int insn;
7411
7412 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7413 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7414 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7415 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7416 {
7417 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7418 {
7419 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7420 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7421 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7422 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7423 }
7424 }
7425 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7426 info->callbacks->einfo
7427 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7428 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7429 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7430 }
7431 break;
7432 }
7433
7434 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7435 && h != NULL
7436 && !h->def_regular
7437 && h->protected_def
7438 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7439 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7440 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7441 {
7442 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7443 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7444 unsigned int insn;
7445
7446 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7447 {
7448 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7449 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7450 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7451 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7452 {
7453 bfd_byte *p;
7454 bfd_vma off;
7455 bfd_vma got_addr;
7456
7457 p = (contents + input_section->size
7458 - relax_info->workaround_size
7459 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7460 + picfixup_size);
7461 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7462 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7463 info->callbacks->einfo
7464 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7465 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7466
7467 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7468 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7469 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7470 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7471 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7472 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7473 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7474 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7475 insn &= ~0xffff;
7476 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7477 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7478
7479 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7480 insn &= ~0xffff;
7481 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7482 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7483 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7484 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7485
7486 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7487 picfixup_size += 12;
7488
7489 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7490 output is reasonable. */
7491 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7492 wrel++, rel++;
7493 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7494 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7495 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7496
7497 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7498 dynamic reloc. */
7499 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7500 }
7501 else
7502 _bfd_error_handler
7503 /* xgettext:c-format */
7504 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7505 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7506 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7507 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7508 }
7509 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7510 {
7511 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7512 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7513 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7514 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7515 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7516 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7517 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7518 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7519 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7520 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7521 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7522 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7523 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7524 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7525 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7526 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7527 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7528 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7529 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7530 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7531 {
7532 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7533 relocation = 0;
7534 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7535 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7536 }
7537 else
7538 _bfd_error_handler
7539 /* xgettext:c-format */
7540 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7541 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7542 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7543 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7544 }
7545 }
7546
7547 ifunc = NULL;
7548 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7549 {
7550 struct plt_entry *ent;
7551
7552 if (h != NULL)
7553 {
7554 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7555 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7556 }
7557 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7558 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7559 {
7560 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7561
7562 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7563 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7564 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7565 }
7566
7567 ent = NULL;
7568 if (ifunc != NULL
7569 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7570 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7571 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7572 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7573 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7574 {
7575 addend = 0;
7576 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7577 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7578 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7579 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7580 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7581 addend = rel->r_addend;
7582 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7583 }
7584 if (ent != NULL)
7585 {
7586 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7587 && ent->sec != got2
7588 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7589 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7590 || h == NULL
7591 || h->dynindx == -1))
7592 {
7593 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7594 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7595 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7596 apparently are using code compiled with
7597 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7598 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7599 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7600 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7601 into .got2). */
7602 info->callbacks->einfo
7603 /* xgettext:c-format */
7604 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7605 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7606 }
7607
7608 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7609 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7610 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7611 || h == NULL
7612 || h->dynindx == -1)
7613 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7614 + htab->glink->output_offset
7615 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7616 else
7617 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7618 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7619 + ent->plt.offset);
7620 }
7621 }
7622
7623 addend = rel->r_addend;
7624 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7625 howto = NULL;
7626 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7627 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7628
7629 switch (r_type)
7630 {
7631 default:
7632 break;
7633
7634 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7635 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7636 {
7637 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7638 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7639 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7640 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7641 /* xgettext:c-format */
7642 info->callbacks->minfo
7643 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7644 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7645 else
7646 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7647 }
7648 break;
7649
7650 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7651 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7652 {
7653 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7654 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7655 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7656 insn |= 2 << 16;
7657 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7658 }
7659 break;
7660 }
7661
7662 tls_type = 0;
7663 switch (r_type)
7664 {
7665 default:
7666 /* xgettext:c-format */
7667 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7668 input_bfd, howto->name);
7669
7670 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7671 ret = FALSE;
7672 goto copy_reloc;
7673
7674 case R_PPC_NONE:
7675 case R_PPC_TLS:
7676 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7677 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7678 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7679 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7680 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7681 goto copy_reloc;
7682
7683 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7684 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7685 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7686 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7687 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7688 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7689 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7690 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7691 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7692 goto dogot;
7693
7694 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7695 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7696 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7697 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7698 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7699 goto dogot;
7700
7701 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7702 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7703 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7704 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7705 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7706 goto dogot;
7707
7708 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7709 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7710 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7711 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7712 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7713 goto dogot;
7714
7715 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7716 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7717 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7718 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7719 tls_mask = 0;
7720 dogot:
7721 {
7722 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7723 offset table. */
7724 bfd_vma off;
7725 bfd_vma *offp;
7726 unsigned long indx;
7727
7728 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7729 abort ();
7730
7731 indx = 0;
7732 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7733 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7734 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7735 else if (h != NULL)
7736 {
7737 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7738 || h->dynindx == -1
7739 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7740 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7741 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7742 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7743 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7744 because of a version file. */
7745 ;
7746 else
7747 {
7748 indx = h->dynindx;
7749 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7750 }
7751 offp = &h->got.offset;
7752 }
7753 else
7754 {
7755 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7756 abort ();
7757 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7758 }
7759
7760 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7761 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7762 processed this entry. */
7763 off = *offp;
7764 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7765 off &= ~1;
7766 else
7767 {
7768 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7769 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7770 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7771 : 0);
7772
7773 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7774 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7775 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7776 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7777 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7778
7779 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7780 Initialize them all. */
7781 do
7782 {
7783 int tls_ty = 0;
7784
7785 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7786 {
7787 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7788 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7789 }
7790 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7791 {
7792 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7793 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7794 }
7795 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7796 {
7797 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7798 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7799 }
7800 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7801 {
7802 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7803 tls_m = 0;
7804 }
7805
7806 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7807 if (indx != 0
7808 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7809 && (h == NULL
7810 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7811 && !(tls_ty != 0
7812 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7813 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7814 {
7815 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7816 bfd_byte * loc;
7817
7818 if (ifunc != NULL)
7819 {
7820 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7821 if (indx == 0)
7822 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7823 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7824 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7825 }
7826 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7827 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7828 + off);
7829 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7830 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7831 {
7832 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7833 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7834 {
7835 loc = rsec->contents;
7836 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7837 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7838 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7839 &outrel, loc);
7840 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7841 outrel.r_info
7842 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7843 }
7844 }
7845 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7846 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7847 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7848 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7849 else if (indx != 0)
7850 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7851 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7852 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7853 else
7854 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7855 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7856 {
7857 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7858 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7859 {
7860 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7861 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7862 else
7863 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7864 }
7865 }
7866 loc = rsec->contents;
7867 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7868 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7869 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7870 }
7871
7872 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7873 emitting a reloc. */
7874 else
7875 {
7876 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7877
7878 if (tls_ty != 0)
7879 {
7880 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7881 value = 0;
7882 else
7883 {
7884 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7885 value = 0;
7886 else
7887 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7888 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7889 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7890 }
7891
7892 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7893 {
7894 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7895 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7896 value = 1;
7897 }
7898 }
7899 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7900 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7901 }
7902
7903 off += 4;
7904 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7905 off += 4;
7906 }
7907 while (tls_m != 0);
7908
7909 off = *offp;
7910 *offp = off | 1;
7911 }
7912
7913 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7914 abort ();
7915
7916 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7917 {
7918 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7919 {
7920 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7921 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7922 off += 8;
7923 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7924 {
7925 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7926 off += 8;
7927 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7928 {
7929 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7930 off += 4;
7931 }
7932 }
7933 }
7934 }
7935
7936 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7937 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7938 goto copy_reloc;
7939
7940 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7941 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7942 + off
7943 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7944
7945 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7946 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7947 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7948 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7949 if (addend != 0)
7950 info->callbacks->einfo
7951 /* xgettext:c-format */
7952 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7953 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7954 howto->name,
7955 sym_name);
7956 }
7957 break;
7958
7959 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7960 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7961 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7962 at a symbol not in this object. */
7963 if (unresolved_reloc)
7964 {
7965 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7966 h->root.root.string,
7967 input_bfd,
7968 input_section,
7969 rel->r_offset,
7970 TRUE);
7971 goto copy_reloc;
7972 }
7973 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7974 {
7975 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7976 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7977 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7978 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7979 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7980 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7981 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7982 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7983 /* xgettext:c-format */
7984 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7985 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7986 h->root.root.string);
7987 }
7988 break;
7989
7990 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7991 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7992 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7993 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7994 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7995 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7996 break;
7997
7998 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7999 object. */
8000 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8001 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8002 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8003 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8004 if (h != NULL
8005 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8006 && h->dynindx == -1)
8007 {
8008 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8009 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8010 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8011 defined before using them. */
8012 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8013 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8014 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8015 if (insn != 0)
8016 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8017 break;
8018 }
8019 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8020 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8021 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8022 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8023 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8024 goto dodyn;
8025
8026 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8027 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8028 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8029 goto dodyn;
8030
8031 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8032 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8033 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8034 goto dodyn;
8035
8036 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8037 relocation = 1;
8038 addend = 0;
8039 goto dodyn;
8040
8041 case R_PPC_REL16:
8042 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8043 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8044 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8045 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8046 break;
8047
8048 case R_PPC_REL32:
8049 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8050 break;
8051 /* fall through */
8052
8053 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8054 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8055 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8056 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8057 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8058 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8059 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8060 goto dodyn;
8061
8062 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8063 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8064 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8065 case R_PPC_REL24:
8066 case R_PPC_REL14:
8067 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8068 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8069 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8070 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8071 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8072 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8073 break;
8074 /* fall through */
8075
8076 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8077 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8078 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8079 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8080 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8081 break;
8082 /* fall through */
8083
8084 dodyn:
8085 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8086 || is_vxworks_tls)
8087 break;
8088
8089 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8090 ? ((h == NULL
8091 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8092 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8093 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8094 : (h != NULL
8095 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8096 {
8097 int skip;
8098 bfd_byte *loc;
8099 asection *sreloc;
8100 long indx = 0;
8101
8102 #ifdef DEBUG
8103 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8104 "create relocation for %s\n",
8105 (h && h->root.root.string
8106 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8107 #endif
8108
8109 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8110 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8111 time. */
8112 skip = 0;
8113 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8114 input_section,
8115 rel->r_offset);
8116 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8117 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8118 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8119 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8120 + input_section->output_offset);
8121
8122 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8123 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8124 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8125 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8126 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8127 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8128 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8129
8130 if (skip)
8131 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8132 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8133 {
8134 indx = h->dynindx;
8135 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8136 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8137 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8138 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8139 }
8140 else
8141 {
8142 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8143
8144 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8145 {
8146 if (ifunc != NULL)
8147 {
8148 /* If we get here when building a static
8149 executable, then the libc startup function
8150 responsible for applying indirect function
8151 relocations is going to complain about
8152 the reloc type.
8153 If we get here when building a dynamic
8154 executable, it will be because we have
8155 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8156 will set the text segment writable and
8157 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8158 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8159 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8160 info->callbacks->einfo
8161 /* xgettext:c-format */
8162 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8163 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8164 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8165 howto->name,
8166 sym_name);
8167 ret = FALSE;
8168 }
8169 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8170 ;
8171 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8172 {
8173 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8174 ret = FALSE;
8175 }
8176 else
8177 {
8178 asection *osec;
8179
8180 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8181 against a section symbol. It would be
8182 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8183 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8184 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8185 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8186 osec = sec->output_section;
8187 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8188 {
8189 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8190 indx = 0;
8191 }
8192 else
8193 {
8194 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8195 if (indx == 0)
8196 {
8197 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8198 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8199 }
8200 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8201 }
8202
8203 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8204 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8205 addend for them. */
8206 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8207 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8208 }
8209
8210 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8211 }
8212 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8213 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8214 else
8215 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8216 }
8217
8218 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8219 if (ifunc)
8220 {
8221 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8222 if (indx == 0)
8223 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8224 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8225 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8226 }
8227 if (sreloc == NULL)
8228 return FALSE;
8229
8230 loc = sreloc->contents;
8231 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8232 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8233
8234 if (skip == -1)
8235 goto copy_reloc;
8236
8237 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8238 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8239 if (!skip)
8240 {
8241 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8242 addend = 0;
8243 break;
8244 }
8245 }
8246 break;
8247
8248 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8249 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8250 if (h != NULL)
8251 {
8252 struct plt_entry *ent;
8253 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8254
8255 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8256 {
8257 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8258 got2_addend = addend;
8259 addend = 0;
8260 }
8261 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8262 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8263 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8264 + htab->glink->output_offset
8265 + ent->glink_offset);
8266 else
8267 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8268 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8269 + ent->plt.offset);
8270 }
8271 /* Fall through. */
8272
8273 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8274 {
8275 const int *stub;
8276 size_t size;
8277 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8278 unsigned int insn;
8279
8280 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8281 {
8282 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8283 + input_section->output_offset
8284 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8285 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8286 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8287 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8288 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8289 stub += 3;
8290 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8291 }
8292 else
8293 {
8294 stub = stub_entry;
8295 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8296 }
8297
8298 relocation += addend;
8299 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8300 relocation = 0;
8301
8302 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8303 insn = *stub++;
8304 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8305 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8306 insn_offset += 4;
8307
8308 insn = *stub++;
8309 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8310 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8311 insn_offset += 4;
8312 size -= 2;
8313
8314 while (size != 0)
8315 {
8316 insn = *stub++;
8317 --size;
8318 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8319 insn_offset += 4;
8320 }
8321
8322 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8323 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8324 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8325 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8326 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8327 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8328 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8329 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8330 wrel++, rel++;
8331 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8332 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8333 }
8334 continue;
8335
8336 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8337 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8338 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8339 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8340 {
8341 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8342 break;
8343 }
8344 relocation
8345 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8346 h, relocation, rel);
8347 addend = 0;
8348 break;
8349
8350 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8351 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8352 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8353 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8354 {
8355 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8356 break;
8357 }
8358 relocation
8359 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8360 h, relocation, rel);
8361 addend = 0;
8362 break;
8363
8364 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8365 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8366 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8367 AIX .toc section. */
8368 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8369 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8370 {
8371 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8372 break;
8373 }
8374 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8375 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8376
8377 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8378 break;
8379
8380 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8381 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8382 {
8383 struct plt_entry *ent;
8384
8385 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8386 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8387 if (ent == NULL
8388 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8389 {
8390 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8391 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8392 using -Bsymbolic. */
8393 }
8394 else
8395 {
8396 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8397 procedure linkage table. */
8398 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8399 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8400 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8401 + htab->glink->output_offset
8402 + ent->glink_offset);
8403 else
8404 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8405 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8406 + ent->plt.offset);
8407 }
8408 }
8409
8410 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8411 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8412 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8413 addend = 0;
8414 break;
8415
8416 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8417 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8418 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8419 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8420 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8421 plt_list = NULL;
8422 if (h != NULL)
8423 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8424 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8425 plt_list = ifunc;
8426 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8427 {
8428 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8429 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8430 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8431 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8432 }
8433 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8434 if (plt_list != NULL)
8435 {
8436 struct plt_entry *ent;
8437
8438 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8439 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8440 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8441 {
8442 asection *plt;
8443
8444 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8445 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8446 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8447 || h == NULL
8448 || h->dynindx == -1)
8449 {
8450 if (ifunc != NULL)
8451 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8452 else
8453 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8454 }
8455 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8456 + plt->output_offset
8457 + ent->plt.offset);
8458 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8459 {
8460 bfd_vma got = 0;
8461
8462 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8463 got = (ent->addend
8464 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8465 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8466 else
8467 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8468 relocation -= got;
8469 }
8470 }
8471 }
8472 addend = 0;
8473 break;
8474
8475 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8476 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8477 {
8478 const char *name;
8479 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8480
8481 if (sec == NULL
8482 || sec->output_section == NULL
8483 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8484 {
8485 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8486 break;
8487 }
8488 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8489
8490 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8491 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8492 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8493 {
8494 _bfd_error_handler
8495 /* xgettext:c-format */
8496 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8497 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8498 input_bfd,
8499 sym_name,
8500 howto->name,
8501 name);
8502 }
8503 }
8504 break;
8505
8506 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8507 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8508 {
8509 const char *name;
8510 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8511
8512 if (sec == NULL
8513 || sec->output_section == NULL
8514 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8515 {
8516 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8517 break;
8518 }
8519 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8520
8521 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8522 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8523 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8524 {
8525 _bfd_error_handler
8526 /* xgettext:c-format */
8527 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8528 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8529 input_bfd,
8530 sym_name,
8531 howto->name,
8532 name);
8533 }
8534 }
8535 break;
8536
8537 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8538 relocation = relocation + addend;
8539 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8540 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8541 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8542 goto copy_reloc;
8543
8544 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8545 relocation = relocation + addend;
8546 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8547 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8548 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8549 goto copy_reloc;
8550
8551 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8552 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8553 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8554 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8555 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8556 goto copy_reloc;
8557
8558 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8559 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8560 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8561 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8562 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8563 goto copy_reloc;
8564
8565 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8566 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8567 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8568 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8569 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8570 goto copy_reloc;
8571
8572 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8573 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8574 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8575 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8576 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8577 goto copy_reloc;
8578
8579 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8580 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8581 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8582 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8583 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8584 {
8585 const char *name;
8586 int reg;
8587 unsigned int insn;
8588 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8589
8590 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8591 {
8592 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8593 break;
8594 }
8595
8596 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8597 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8598 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8599 {
8600 reg = 13;
8601 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8602 }
8603 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8604 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8605 {
8606 reg = 2;
8607 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8608 }
8609 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8610 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8611 {
8612 reg = 0;
8613 }
8614 else
8615 {
8616 _bfd_error_handler
8617 /* xgettext:c-format */
8618 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8619 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8620 input_bfd,
8621 sym_name,
8622 howto->name,
8623 name);
8624
8625 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8626 ret = FALSE;
8627 goto copy_reloc;
8628 }
8629
8630 if (sda != NULL)
8631 {
8632 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8633 {
8634 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8635 break;
8636 }
8637 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8638 }
8639
8640 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8641 break;
8642
8643 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8644 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8645 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8646 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8647 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8648 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8649 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8650 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8651 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8652
8653 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8654 if (reg == 0
8655 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8656 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8657 {
8658 relocation = relocation + addend;
8659 addend = 0;
8660
8661 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8662 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8663 insn |= 28u << 26;
8664
8665 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8666 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8667 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8668 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8669 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8670 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8671 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8672
8673 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8674
8675 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8676 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8677 goto overflow;
8678 goto copy_reloc;
8679 }
8680 /* Fill in register field. */
8681 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8682 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8683 }
8684 break;
8685
8686 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8687 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8688 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8689 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8690 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8691 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8692 {
8693 bfd_vma value;
8694 const char *name;
8695 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8696
8697 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8698 {
8699 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8700 break;
8701 }
8702
8703 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8704 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8705 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8706 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8707 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8708 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8709 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8710 else
8711 {
8712 _bfd_error_handler
8713 /* xgettext:c-format */
8714 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8715 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8716 input_bfd,
8717 sym_name,
8718 howto->name,
8719 name);
8720
8721 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8722 ret = FALSE;
8723 goto copy_reloc;
8724 }
8725
8726 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8727 {
8728 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8729 break;
8730 }
8731 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8732
8733 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8734 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8735 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8736 split16a_type,
8737 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8738 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8739 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8740 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8741 split16d_type,
8742 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8743 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8744 {
8745 value = value >> 16;
8746 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8747 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8748 split16a_type,
8749 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8750 }
8751 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8752 {
8753 value = value >> 16;
8754 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8755 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8756 split16d_type,
8757 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8758 }
8759 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8760 {
8761 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8762 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8763 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8764 split16a_type,
8765 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8766 }
8767 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8768 {
8769 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8770 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8771 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8772 split16d_type,
8773 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8774 }
8775 }
8776 goto copy_reloc;
8777
8778 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8779 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8780 continue;
8781
8782 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8783 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8784 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8785 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8786 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8787 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8788 {
8789 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8790 break;
8791 }
8792 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8793 break;
8794
8795 /* Negative relocations. */
8796 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8797 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8798 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8799 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8800 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8801 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8802 break;
8803
8804 case R_PPC_COPY:
8805 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8806 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8807 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8808 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8809 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8810 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8811 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8812 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8813 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8814 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8815 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8816 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8817 /* xgettext:c-format */
8818 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8819 input_bfd, howto->name);
8820
8821 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8822 ret = FALSE;
8823 goto copy_reloc;
8824 }
8825
8826 switch (r_type)
8827 {
8828 default:
8829 break;
8830
8831 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8832 if (unresolved_reloc)
8833 {
8834 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8835 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8836 insn &= 1;
8837 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8838 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8839 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8840 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8841 }
8842 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8843 info->callbacks->einfo
8844 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8845 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8846 howto->name);
8847 break;
8848
8849 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8850 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8851 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8852 if (unresolved_reloc)
8853 {
8854 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8855 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8856 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8857 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8858 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8859 }
8860 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8861 info->callbacks->einfo
8862 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8863 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8864 howto->name);
8865 break;
8866 }
8867
8868 /* Do any further special processing. */
8869 switch (r_type)
8870 {
8871 default:
8872 break;
8873
8874 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8875 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8876 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8877 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8878 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8879 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8880 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8881 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8882 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8883 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8884 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8885 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8886 if (sec == NULL)
8887 break;
8888 /* Fall through. */
8889
8890 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8891 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8892 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8893 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8894 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8895 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8896 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8897 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8898 addend += 0x8000;
8899 break;
8900
8901 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8902 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8903 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8904 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8905 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8906 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8907 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8908 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8909 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8910 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8911 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8912 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8913 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8914 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8915 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8917 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8918 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8919 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8920 {
8921 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8922 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8923 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8924 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8925
8926 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8927 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8928 mask = 0;
8929 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8930 mask = 3;
8931 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8932 mask = 15;
8933 else
8934 break;
8935 relocation += addend;
8936 addend = insn & mask;
8937 lobit = mask & relocation;
8938 if (lobit != 0)
8939 {
8940 relocation ^= lobit;
8941 info->callbacks->einfo
8942 /* xgettext:c-format */
8943 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8944 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8945 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8946 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8947 ret = FALSE;
8948 }
8949 }
8950 break;
8951 }
8952
8953 #ifdef DEBUG
8954 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8955 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8956 howto->name,
8957 (int) r_type,
8958 sym_name,
8959 r_symndx,
8960 (long) rel->r_offset,
8961 (long) addend);
8962 #endif
8963
8964 if (unresolved_reloc
8965 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8966 && h->def_dynamic)
8967 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8968 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8969 {
8970 info->callbacks->einfo
8971 /* xgettext:c-format */
8972 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8973 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8974 howto->name,
8975 sym_name);
8976 ret = FALSE;
8977 }
8978
8979 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8980 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8981 have different reloc types. */
8982 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8983 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8984 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8985 {
8986 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8987
8988 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8989 {
8990 unsigned int insn;
8991
8992 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8993 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8994 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8995 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8996 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
8997 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
8998 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
8999 }
9000 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9001 {
9002 alt_howto = *howto;
9003 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9004 howto = &alt_howto;
9005 }
9006 }
9007
9008 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9009 {
9010 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9011 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9012 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9013 else
9014 {
9015 unsigned int insn;
9016
9017 relocation += addend;
9018 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9019 + input_section->output_offset
9020 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9021 relocation >>= 16;
9022 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9023 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9024 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9025 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9026 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9027 }
9028 }
9029 else
9030 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9031 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9032
9033 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9034 {
9035 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9036 {
9037 overflow:
9038 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9039 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9040 if (!warned
9041 && !(h != NULL
9042 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9043 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9044 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9045 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9046 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9047 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9048 }
9049 else
9050 {
9051 info->callbacks->einfo
9052 /* xgettext:c-format */
9053 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9054 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9055 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9056 ret = FALSE;
9057 }
9058 }
9059 copy_reloc:
9060 if (wrel != rel)
9061 *wrel = *rel;
9062 }
9063
9064 if (wrel != rel)
9065 {
9066 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9067 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9068
9069 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9070 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9071 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9072 {
9073 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9074 one NONE reloc.
9075 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9076 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9077 deleted -= 1;
9078 wrel++;
9079 }
9080 relend = wrel;
9081 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9082 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9083 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9084 }
9085
9086 #ifdef DEBUG
9087 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9088 #endif
9089
9090 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9091 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9092 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9093 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9094 {
9095 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9096 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9097 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9098 }
9099
9100 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9101 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9102 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9103 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9104 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9105 {
9106 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9107 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9108
9109 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9110 {
9111 bfd_byte *p;
9112 unsigned int n;
9113 bfd_byte fill[4];
9114
9115 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9116 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9117 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9118 while (n--)
9119 {
9120 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9121 p += 4;
9122 }
9123 }
9124
9125 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9126 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9127 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9128 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9129 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9130
9131 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9132 + input_section->output_offset);
9133 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9134 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9135 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9136 addr < end_addr;
9137 addr += pagesize)
9138 {
9139 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9140 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9141 bfd_boolean is_data;
9142 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9143 unsigned int insn;
9144
9145 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9146 the word alone. */
9147 is_data = FALSE;
9148 lo = relocs;
9149 hi = relend;
9150 rel = NULL;
9151 while (lo < hi)
9152 {
9153 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9154 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9155 lo = rel + 1;
9156 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9157 hi = rel;
9158 else
9159 {
9160 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9161 {
9162 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9163 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9164 case R_PPC_REL32:
9165 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9166 is_data = TRUE;
9167 break;
9168 default:
9169 break;
9170 }
9171 break;
9172 }
9173 }
9174 if (is_data)
9175 continue;
9176
9177 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9178 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9179 avoid the icache failure.
9180
9181 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9182 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9183 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9184 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9185 unconditional branches:
9186 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9187 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9188 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9189 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9190 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9191 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9192 instruction is not executed.
9193
9194 A bctr example:
9195 .
9196 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9197 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9198 . mtctr 9
9199 . bctr
9200 . nop
9201 . nop
9202 . new_page:
9203 .
9204 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9205 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9206 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9207 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9208 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9209 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9210 place:
9211 .
9212 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9213 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9214 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9215 . bctr bctr
9216 . nop b somewhere_else
9217 . b somewhere_else nop
9218 . new_page: new_page:
9219 . */
9220 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9221 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9222 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9223 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9224 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9225 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9226 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9227 continue;
9228
9229 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9230 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9231 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9232 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9233 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9234
9235 if (rel != NULL
9236 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9237 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9238 {
9239 asection *sreloc;
9240
9241 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9242 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9243 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9244 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9245 {
9246 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9247
9248 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9249 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9250 relend[-1] = tmp;
9251 }
9252 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9253
9254 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9255 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9256 {
9257 case R_PPC_REL16:
9258 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9259 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9260 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9261 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9262 break;
9263 default:
9264 break;
9265 }
9266
9267 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9268 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9269 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9270 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9271 if (sreloc != NULL)
9272 {
9273 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9274 bfd_vma soffset;
9275
9276 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9277 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9278 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9279 + input_section->output_offset);
9280 while (slo < shi)
9281 {
9282 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9283 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9284 &outrel);
9285 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9286 slo = srel + 1;
9287 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9288 shi = srel;
9289 else
9290 {
9291 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9292 {
9293 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9294 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9295 srel = srelend - 1;
9296 }
9297 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9298 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9299 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9300 break;
9301 }
9302 }
9303 }
9304 }
9305 else
9306 rel = NULL;
9307
9308 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9309 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9310 {
9311 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9312
9313 delta += offset - patch_off;
9314 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9315 delta = 0;
9316 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9317 {
9318 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9319
9320 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9321 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9322 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9323 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9324 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9325 else
9326 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9327
9328 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9329 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9330 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9331 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9332 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9333 }
9334 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9335 {
9336 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9337 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9338 contents + patch_off);
9339 patch_off += 4;
9340 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9341 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9342 contents + patch_off);
9343 patch_off += 4;
9344 }
9345 else
9346 {
9347 if (rel != NULL)
9348 {
9349 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9350
9351 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9352 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9353 }
9354 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9355 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9356 contents + patch_off);
9357 patch_off += 4;
9358 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9359 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9360 contents + patch_off);
9361 patch_off += 4;
9362 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9363 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9364 contents + patch_off);
9365 patch_off += 4;
9366 }
9367 }
9368 else
9369 {
9370 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9371 patch_off += 4;
9372 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9373 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9374 contents + patch_off);
9375 patch_off += 4;
9376 }
9377 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9378 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9379 }
9380 }
9381
9382 return ret;
9383 }
9384 \f
9385 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9386
9387 static bfd_boolean
9388 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9389 {
9390 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9391 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9392 struct plt_entry *ent;
9393 bfd_boolean doneone;
9394
9395 doneone = FALSE;
9396 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9397 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9398 {
9399 if (!doneone)
9400 {
9401 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9402 bfd_byte *loc;
9403 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9404 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9405 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9406
9407 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9408 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9409 || h->dynindx == -1)
9410 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9411 else
9412 {
9413 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9414 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9415 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9416 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9417 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9418 }
9419
9420 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9421 Set it up. */
9422 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9423 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9424 && h->dynindx != -1)
9425 {
9426 bfd_vma got_offset;
9427 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9428
9429 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9430 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9431
9432 /* Use the right PLT. */
9433 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9434 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9435
9436 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9437 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9438 {
9439 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9440 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9441 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9442 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9443 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9444 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9445 }
9446 else
9447 {
9448 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9449
9450 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9451 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9452 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9453 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9454 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9455 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9456 }
9457
9458 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9459 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9460 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9461 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9462
9463 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9464 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9465 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9466 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9467 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9468 prescaled offset. */
9469 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9470 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9471 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9472 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9473 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9474 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9475 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9476 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9477 offset. */
9478 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9479 (plt_entry[5]
9480 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9481 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9482 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9483 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9484 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9485 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9486
9487 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9488 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9489 in this PLT entry. */
9490 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9491 + plt->output_offset
9492 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9493 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9494
9495 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9496 {
9497 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9498 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9499 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9500 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9501 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9502
9503 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9504 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9505 + plt->output_offset
9506 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9507 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9508 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9509 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9510 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9511 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9512
9513 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9514 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9515 + plt->output_offset
9516 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9517 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9518 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9519 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9520 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9521 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9522
9523 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9524 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9525 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9526 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9527 + got_offset);
9528 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9529 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9530 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9531 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9532 }
9533
9534 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9535 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9536 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9537 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9538 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9539 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9540 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9541 + got_offset);
9542 rela.r_addend = 0;
9543 }
9544 else
9545 {
9546 rela.r_addend = 0;
9547 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9548 || h->dynindx == -1)
9549 {
9550 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9551 {
9552 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9553 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9554 }
9555 else
9556 {
9557 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9558 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9559 }
9560 if (h->def_regular
9561 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9562 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9563 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9564 }
9565
9566 if (relplt == NULL)
9567 {
9568 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9569 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9570 }
9571 else
9572 {
9573 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9574 + plt->output_offset
9575 + ent->plt.offset);
9576
9577 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9578 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9579 || h->dynindx == -1)
9580 {
9581 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9582 linker will fill it in. */
9583 }
9584 else
9585 {
9586 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9587 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9588 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9589 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9590 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9591 }
9592 }
9593 }
9594
9595 if (relplt != NULL)
9596 {
9597 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9598 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9599 || h->dynindx == -1)
9600 {
9601 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9602 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9603 else
9604 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9605 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9606 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9607 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9608 }
9609 else
9610 {
9611 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9612 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9613 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9614 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9615 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9616 }
9617 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9618 }
9619 doneone = TRUE;
9620 }
9621
9622 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9623 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9624 || h->dynindx == -1)
9625 {
9626 unsigned char *p;
9627 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9628
9629 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9630 || h->dynindx == -1)
9631 {
9632 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9633 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9634 else
9635 break;
9636 }
9637
9638 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9639 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9640
9641 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9642 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9643 break;
9644 }
9645 else
9646 break;
9647 }
9648 return TRUE;
9649 }
9650
9651 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9652
9653 bfd_boolean
9654 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9655 {
9656 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9657 bfd *ibfd;
9658
9659 if (!htab)
9660 return TRUE;
9661
9662 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9663
9664 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9665 {
9666 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9667 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9668 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9669 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9670 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9671 struct plt_entry *ent;
9672
9673 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9674 continue;
9675
9676 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9677 if (!local_got)
9678 continue;
9679
9680 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9681 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9682 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9683 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9684 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9685 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9686 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9687 {
9688 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9689 {
9690 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9691 asection *sym_sec;
9692 asection *plt, *relplt;
9693 bfd_byte *loc;
9694 bfd_vma val;
9695 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9696 unsigned char *p;
9697
9698 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9699 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9700 {
9701 if (local_syms != NULL
9702 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9703 free (local_syms);
9704 return FALSE;
9705 }
9706
9707 val = sym->st_value;
9708 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9709 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9710
9711 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9712 {
9713 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9714 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9715 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9716 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9717 }
9718 else
9719 {
9720 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9721 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9722 {
9723 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9724 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9725 }
9726 else
9727 {
9728 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9729 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9730 continue;
9731 }
9732 }
9733
9734 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9735 + plt->output_offset
9736 + plt->output_section->vma);
9737 rela.r_addend = val;
9738 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9739 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9740 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9741
9742 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9743 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9744 }
9745 }
9746
9747 if (local_syms != NULL
9748 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9749 {
9750 if (!info->keep_memory)
9751 free (local_syms);
9752 else
9753 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9754 }
9755 }
9756 return TRUE;
9757 }
9758
9759 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9760 dynamic sections here. */
9761
9762 static bfd_boolean
9763 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9764 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9765 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9766 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9767 {
9768 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9769 struct plt_entry *ent;
9770
9771 #ifdef DEBUG
9772 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9773 h->root.root.string);
9774 #endif
9775
9776 if (!h->def_regular
9777 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9778 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9779 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9780 {
9781 if (!h->def_regular)
9782 {
9783 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9784 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9785 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9786 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9787 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9788 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9789 to zero. */
9790 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9791 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9792 sym->st_value = 0;
9793 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9794 {
9795 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9796 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9797 function pointer. */
9798 sym->st_value = 0;
9799 }
9800 }
9801 else
9802 {
9803 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9804 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9805 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9806 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9807 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9808 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9809 relocation. */
9810 sym->st_shndx
9811 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9812 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9813 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9814 + htab->glink->output_offset
9815 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9816 }
9817 break;
9818 }
9819
9820 if (h->needs_copy)
9821 {
9822 asection *s;
9823 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9824 bfd_byte *loc;
9825
9826 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9827
9828 #ifdef DEBUG
9829 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9830 #endif
9831
9832 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9833
9834 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9835 s = htab->relsbss;
9836 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9837 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9838 else
9839 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9840 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9841
9842 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9843 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9844 rela.r_addend = 0;
9845 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9846 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9847 }
9848
9849 #ifdef DEBUG
9850 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9851 #endif
9852
9853 return TRUE;
9854 }
9855 \f
9856 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9857 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9858 const asection *rel_sec,
9859 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9860 {
9861 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9862
9863 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9864 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9865
9866 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9867 {
9868 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9869 return reloc_class_relative;
9870 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9871 return reloc_class_plt;
9872 case R_PPC_COPY:
9873 return reloc_class_copy;
9874 default:
9875 return reloc_class_normal;
9876 }
9877 }
9878 \f
9879 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9880
9881 static bfd_boolean
9882 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9883 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9884 {
9885 asection *sdyn;
9886 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9887 bfd_vma got;
9888 bfd *dynobj;
9889 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9890
9891 #ifdef DEBUG
9892 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9893 #endif
9894
9895 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9896 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9897 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9898
9899 got = 0;
9900 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9901 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9902
9903 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9904 {
9905 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9906
9907 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9908
9909 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9910 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9911 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9912 {
9913 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9914 asection *s;
9915
9916 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9917
9918 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9919 {
9920 case DT_PLTGOT:
9921 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9922 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9923 else
9924 s = htab->elf.splt;
9925 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9926 break;
9927
9928 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9929 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9930 break;
9931
9932 case DT_JMPREL:
9933 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9934 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9935 break;
9936
9937 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9938 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9939 break;
9940
9941 case DT_TEXTREL:
9942 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9943 info->callbacks->einfo
9944 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9945 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9946 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9947 info->callbacks->einfo
9948 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9949 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9950 continue;
9951
9952 default:
9953 if (htab->is_vxworks
9954 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9955 break;
9956 continue;
9957 }
9958
9959 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9960 }
9961 }
9962
9963 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9964 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9965 {
9966 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9967 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9968 {
9969 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9970
9971 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9972 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9973 {
9974 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9975 so that a function can easily find the address of
9976 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9977 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9978 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9979 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9980 }
9981
9982 if (sdyn != NULL)
9983 {
9984 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9985 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9986 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9987 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9988 }
9989 }
9990 else
9991 {
9992 /* xgettext:c-format */
9993 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9994 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9995 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9996 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
9997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9998 ret = FALSE;
9999 }
10000
10001 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10002 }
10003
10004 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10005 if (htab->is_vxworks
10006 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10007 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10008 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10009 {
10010 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10011 /* Use the right PLT. */
10012 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10013 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10014 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10015
10016 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10017 {
10018 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10019
10020 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10021 splt->contents + 0);
10022 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10023 splt->contents + 4);
10024 }
10025 else
10026 {
10027 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10028 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10029 }
10030 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10031 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10032 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10033 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10034 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10035 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10036
10037 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10038 {
10039 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10040 bfd_byte *loc;
10041
10042 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10043
10044 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10045 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10046 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10047 + 2);
10048 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10049 rela.r_addend = 0;
10050 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10051 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10052
10053 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10054 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10055 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10056 + 6);
10057 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10058 rela.r_addend = 0;
10059 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10060 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10061
10062 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10063 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10064 in which symbols were output. */
10065 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10066 {
10067 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10068
10069 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10070 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10071 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10072 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10073
10074 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10075 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10076 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10077 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10078
10079 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10080 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10081 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10082 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10083 }
10084 }
10085 }
10086
10087 if (htab->glink != NULL
10088 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10089 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10090 {
10091 unsigned char *p;
10092 unsigned char *endp;
10093 bfd_vma res0;
10094
10095 /*
10096 * PIC glink code is the following:
10097 *
10098 * # ith PLT code stub.
10099 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10100 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10101 * mtctr 11
10102 * bctr
10103 *
10104 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10105 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10106 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10107 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10108 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10109 * .
10110 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10111 * res_n_m3: nop
10112 * res_n_m2: nop
10113 * res_n_m1:
10114 *
10115 * PLTresolve:
10116 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10117 * mflr 0
10118 * bcl 20,31,1f
10119 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10120 * mflr 12
10121 * mtlr 0
10122 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10123 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10124 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10125 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10126 * mtctr 0
10127 * add 0,11,11
10128 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10129 * bctr
10130 *
10131 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10132 *
10133 * # ith PLT code stub.
10134 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10135 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10136 * mtctr 11
10137 * bctr
10138 *
10139 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10140 *
10141 * PLTresolve:
10142 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10143 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10144 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10145 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10146 * mtctr 0
10147 * add 0,11,11
10148 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10149 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10150 * bctr
10151 */
10152
10153 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10154 and perhaps some padding. */
10155 p = htab->glink->contents;
10156 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10157 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10158 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10159 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10160 {
10161 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10162 p += 4;
10163 }
10164 while (p < endp)
10165 {
10166 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10167 p += 4;
10168 }
10169
10170 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10171 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10172 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10173
10174 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10175 {
10176 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10177 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10178 glink branch table. */
10179 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10180 bfd_vma page_addr;
10181 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10182 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10183
10184 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10185 page_addr > glink_start;
10186 page_addr -= pagesize)
10187 {
10188 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10189 bfd_byte *loc;
10190 unsigned int insn;
10191
10192 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10193 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10194 if (insn == BCTR)
10195 {
10196 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10197 one other call stub before this one. */
10198 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10199 if (insn == BCTR)
10200 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10201 else
10202 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10203 }
10204 }
10205 }
10206
10207 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10208 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10209 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10210 {
10211 bfd_vma bcl;
10212
10213 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10214 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10215 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10216
10217 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10218 p += 4;
10219 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10220 p += 4;
10221 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10222 p += 4;
10223 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10224 p += 4;
10225 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10226 p += 4;
10227 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10228 p += 4;
10229 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10230 p += 4;
10231 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10232 p += 4;
10233 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10234 {
10235 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10236 p += 4;
10237 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10238 p += 4;
10239 }
10240 else
10241 {
10242 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10243 p += 4;
10244 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10245 p += 4;
10246 }
10247 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10248 p += 4;
10249 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10250 }
10251 else
10252 {
10253 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10254 p += 4;
10255 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10256 p += 4;
10257 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10258 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10259 else
10260 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10261 p += 4;
10262 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10263 p += 4;
10264 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10265 p += 4;
10266 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10267 p += 4;
10268 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10270 else
10271 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10272 }
10273 p += 4;
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10275 p += 4;
10276 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10277 p += 4;
10278 while (p < endp)
10279 {
10280 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10281 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10282 p += 4;
10283 }
10284 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10285 }
10286
10287 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10288 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10289 {
10290 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10291 bfd_vma val;
10292
10293 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10294 /* FDE length. */
10295 p += 4;
10296 /* CIE pointer. */
10297 p += 4;
10298 /* Offset to .glink. */
10299 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10300 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10301 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10302 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10303 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10304 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10305
10306 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10307 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10308 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10309 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10310 return FALSE;
10311 }
10312
10313 return ret;
10314 }
10315 \f
10316 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10317 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10318 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10319 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10320 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10321 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10322 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10323 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10324 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10325 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10326 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10327
10328 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10329 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10330 #endif
10331
10332 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10333 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10334 #endif
10335
10336 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10337 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10338 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10339 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10340 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10341 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10342
10343 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10344 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10345 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10346 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10347 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10348 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10349 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10350 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10351
10352 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10353 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10354 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10355 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10356 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10357 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10358 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10359 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10360 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10361 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10362 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10363 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10364 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10365 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10366 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10367 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10368 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10369 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10370 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10371 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10372 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10373 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10374 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10375 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10376 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10377 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10378 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10379 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10380 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10381
10382 #include "elf32-target.h"
10383
10384 /* FreeBSD Target */
10385
10386 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10387 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10388
10389 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10390 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10391 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10392 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10393
10394 #undef ELF_OSABI
10395 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10396
10397 #undef elf32_bed
10398 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10399
10400 #include "elf32-target.h"
10401
10402 /* VxWorks Target */
10403
10404 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10405 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10406
10407 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10408 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10409 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10410 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10411
10412 #undef ELF_OSABI
10413
10414 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10415 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10416 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10417 {
10418 if (sec->name == NULL)
10419 return NULL;
10420
10421 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10422 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10423
10424 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10425 }
10426
10427 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10428 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10429 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10430 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10431 {
10432 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10433
10434 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10435 if (ret)
10436 {
10437 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10438 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10439 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10440 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10441 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10442 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10443 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10444 }
10445 return ret;
10446 }
10447
10448 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10449 static bfd_boolean
10450 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10451 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10452 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10453 const char **namep,
10454 flagword *flagsp,
10455 asection **secp,
10456 bfd_vma *valp)
10457 {
10458 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10459 valp))
10460 return FALSE;
10461
10462 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10463 }
10464
10465 static bfd_boolean
10466 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10467 {
10468 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10469 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10470 }
10471
10472 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10473 define it. */
10474 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10475 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10476 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10477 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10478 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10479 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10480 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10481 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10482 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10483 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10484 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10485 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10486 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10487 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10488
10489 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10490
10491 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10492 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10493 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10494 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10495 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10496 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10497 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10498 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10499 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10500 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10501 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10502 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10503 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10504 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10505 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10506 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10507 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10508 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10509
10510 #undef elf32_bed
10511 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10512
10513 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.945665 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.